blob: b1b52fb1c5778e20aaee793bef556ceda2ab2424 [file] [log] [blame]
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001//===--- ASTContext.cpp - Context to hold long-lived AST nodes ------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner0bc735f2007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements the ASTContext interface.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Chandler Carruth55fc8732012-12-04 09:13:33 +000015#include "CXXABI.h"
Benjamin Kramer2fa67ef2012-12-01 15:09:41 +000016#include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h"
17#include "clang/AST/Attr.h"
Ken Dyckbdc601b2009-12-22 14:23:30 +000018#include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h"
Benjamin Kramer2fa67ef2012-12-01 15:09:41 +000019#include "clang/AST/Comment.h"
Dmitri Gribenkoaa580812012-08-09 00:03:17 +000020#include "clang/AST/CommentCommandTraits.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49aa7ff2008-08-07 20:55:28 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h"
Steve Naroff980e5082007-10-01 19:00:59 +000022#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregoraaba5e32009-02-04 19:02:06 +000023#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Daniel Dunbare91593e2008-08-11 04:54:23 +000024#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Douglas Gregor2cf26342009-04-09 22:27:44 +000026#include "clang/AST/ExternalASTSource.h"
Peter Collingbourne14110472011-01-13 18:57:25 +000027#include "clang/AST/Mangle.h"
Benjamin Kramer2fa67ef2012-12-01 15:09:41 +000028#include "clang/AST/RecordLayout.h"
Reid Klecknercff15122013-06-17 12:56:08 +000029#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Benjamin Kramer2fa67ef2012-12-01 15:09:41 +000030#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Chris Lattner1b63e4f2009-06-14 01:54:56 +000031#include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h"
Chris Lattnera9376d42009-03-28 03:45:20 +000032#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000033#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Benjamin Kramerf5942a42009-10-24 09:57:09 +000034#include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
Anders Carlsson85f9bce2007-10-29 05:01:08 +000035#include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h"
Benjamin Kramer2fa67ef2012-12-01 15:09:41 +000036#include "llvm/Support/Capacity.h"
Nate Begeman6fe7c8a2009-01-18 06:42:49 +000037#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Benjamin Kramerf5942a42009-10-24 09:57:09 +000038#include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidis26361972011-05-17 00:46:38 +000039#include <map>
Anders Carlsson29445a02009-07-18 21:19:52 +000040
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000041using namespace clang;
42
Douglas Gregor18274032010-07-03 00:47:00 +000043unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructors;
44unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor22584312010-07-02 23:41:54 +000045unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructors;
46unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared;
Sean Huntffe37fd2011-05-25 20:50:04 +000047unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructors;
48unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregora376d102010-07-02 21:50:04 +000049unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators;
50unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Sean Huntffe37fd2011-05-25 20:50:04 +000051unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators;
52unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor4923aa22010-07-02 20:37:36 +000053unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructors;
54unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared;
55
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000056enum FloatingRank {
Anton Korobeynikovaa4a99b2011-10-14 23:23:15 +000057 HalfRank, FloatRank, DoubleRank, LongDoubleRank
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000058};
59
Dmitri Gribenkoa5ef44f2012-07-11 21:38:39 +000060RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(const Decl *D) const {
Dmitri Gribenkoaa0cd852012-06-20 00:34:58 +000061 if (!CommentsLoaded && ExternalSource) {
62 ExternalSource->ReadComments();
63 CommentsLoaded = true;
64 }
65
66 assert(D);
67
Dmitri Gribenkoc3fee352012-06-28 16:19:39 +000068 // User can not attach documentation to implicit declarations.
69 if (D->isImplicit())
70 return NULL;
71
Dmitri Gribenkoc41ace92012-08-14 17:17:18 +000072 // User can not attach documentation to implicit instantiations.
73 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
74 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
75 return NULL;
76 }
77
Dmitri Gribenkodce750b2012-08-20 22:36:31 +000078 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
79 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
80 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
81 return NULL;
82 }
83
84 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
85 if (CRD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
86 return NULL;
87 }
88
Dmitri Gribenkod1e5c0d2013-01-27 21:18:39 +000089 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
90 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) {
91 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = CTSD->getSpecializationKind();
92 if (TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation ||
93 TSK == TSK_Undeclared)
94 return NULL;
95 }
96
Dmitri Gribenkodce750b2012-08-20 22:36:31 +000097 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
98 if (ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
99 return NULL;
100 }
Fariborz Jahanian099ecfb2013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000101 if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
102 // When tag declaration (but not definition!) is part of the
103 // decl-specifier-seq of some other declaration, it doesn't get comment
104 if (TD->isEmbeddedInDeclarator() && !TD->isCompleteDefinition())
105 return NULL;
106 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaa0cd852012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000107 // TODO: handle comments for function parameters properly.
108 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D))
109 return NULL;
110
Dmitri Gribenko96b09862012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000111 // TODO: we could look up template parameter documentation in the template
112 // documentation.
113 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(D) ||
114 isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(D) ||
115 isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(D))
116 return NULL;
117
Dmitri Gribenko811c8202012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000118 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
Dmitri Gribenkoaa0cd852012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000119
120 // If there are no comments anywhere, we won't find anything.
121 if (RawComments.empty())
122 return NULL;
123
Dmitri Gribenkoabd56c82012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000124 // Find declaration location.
125 // For Objective-C declarations we generally don't expect to have multiple
126 // declarators, thus use declaration starting location as the "declaration
127 // location".
128 // For all other declarations multiple declarators are used quite frequently,
129 // so we use the location of the identifier as the "declaration location".
130 SourceLocation DeclLoc;
131 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko96b09862012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000132 isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenkoc27bc802012-08-02 20:49:51 +0000133 isa<RedeclarableTemplateDecl>(D) ||
134 isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D))
Dmitri Gribenkoabd56c82012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000135 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
Fariborz Jahanianceaa1ec2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000136 else {
Dmitri Gribenkoabd56c82012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000137 DeclLoc = D->getLocation();
Fariborz Jahanianceaa1ec2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000138 // If location of the typedef name is in a macro, it is because being
139 // declared via a macro. Try using declaration's starting location
140 // as the "declaration location".
141 if (DeclLoc.isMacroID() && isa<TypedefDecl>(D))
142 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
143 }
Dmitri Gribenkoabd56c82012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000144
Dmitri Gribenkoaa0cd852012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000145 // If the declaration doesn't map directly to a location in a file, we
146 // can't find the comment.
Dmitri Gribenkoaa0cd852012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000147 if (DeclLoc.isInvalid() || !DeclLoc.isFileID())
148 return NULL;
149
150 // Find the comment that occurs just after this declaration.
Dmitri Gribenkoa444f182012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000151 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator Comment;
152 {
153 // When searching for comments during parsing, the comment we are looking
154 // for is usually among the last two comments we parsed -- check them
155 // first.
Dmitri Gribenko6fd7d302013-04-10 15:35:17 +0000156 RawComment CommentAtDeclLoc(
157 SourceMgr, SourceRange(DeclLoc), false,
158 LangOpts.CommentOpts.ParseAllComments);
Dmitri Gribenkoa444f182012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000159 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment> Compare(SourceMgr);
160 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator MaybeBeforeDecl = RawComments.end() - 1;
161 bool Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
162 if (!Found && RawComments.size() >= 2) {
163 MaybeBeforeDecl--;
164 Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
165 }
166
167 if (Found) {
168 Comment = MaybeBeforeDecl + 1;
169 assert(Comment == std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
170 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare));
171 } else {
172 // Slow path.
173 Comment = std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
174 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare);
175 }
176 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaa0cd852012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000177
178 // Decompose the location for the declaration and find the beginning of the
179 // file buffer.
180 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> DeclLocDecomp = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc(DeclLoc);
181
182 // First check whether we have a trailing comment.
183 if (Comment != RawComments.end() &&
Dmitri Gribenko811c8202012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000184 (*Comment)->isDocumentation() && (*Comment)->isTrailingComment() &&
Fariborz Jahanian8c238be2013-08-06 23:29:00 +0000185 (isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<EnumConstantDecl>(D) || isa<VarDecl>(D) ||
Fariborz Jahanian15c8e562013-08-07 16:40:29 +0000186 isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D))) {
Dmitri Gribenkoaa0cd852012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000187 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentBeginDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko811c8202012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000188 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getBegin());
Dmitri Gribenkoaa0cd852012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000189 // Check that Doxygen trailing comment comes after the declaration, starts
190 // on the same line and in the same file as the declaration.
191 if (DeclLocDecomp.first == CommentBeginDecomp.first &&
192 SourceMgr.getLineNumber(DeclLocDecomp.first, DeclLocDecomp.second)
193 == SourceMgr.getLineNumber(CommentBeginDecomp.first,
194 CommentBeginDecomp.second)) {
Dmitri Gribenko811c8202012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000195 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaa0cd852012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000196 }
197 }
198
199 // The comment just after the declaration was not a trailing comment.
200 // Let's look at the previous comment.
201 if (Comment == RawComments.begin())
202 return NULL;
203 --Comment;
204
205 // Check that we actually have a non-member Doxygen comment.
Dmitri Gribenko811c8202012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000206 if (!(*Comment)->isDocumentation() || (*Comment)->isTrailingComment())
Dmitri Gribenkoaa0cd852012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000207 return NULL;
208
209 // Decompose the end of the comment.
210 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentEndDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko811c8202012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000211 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Dmitri Gribenkoaa0cd852012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000212
213 // If the comment and the declaration aren't in the same file, then they
214 // aren't related.
215 if (DeclLocDecomp.first != CommentEndDecomp.first)
216 return NULL;
217
218 // Get the corresponding buffer.
219 bool Invalid = false;
220 const char *Buffer = SourceMgr.getBufferData(DeclLocDecomp.first,
221 &Invalid).data();
222 if (Invalid)
223 return NULL;
224
225 // Extract text between the comment and declaration.
226 StringRef Text(Buffer + CommentEndDecomp.second,
227 DeclLocDecomp.second - CommentEndDecomp.second);
228
Dmitri Gribenko8bdb58a2012-06-27 23:43:37 +0000229 // There should be no other declarations or preprocessor directives between
230 // comment and declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisdc663262013-07-26 18:38:12 +0000231 if (Text.find_first_of(";{}#@") != StringRef::npos)
Dmitri Gribenkoaa0cd852012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000232 return NULL;
233
Dmitri Gribenko811c8202012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000234 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaa0cd852012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000235}
236
Dmitri Gribenkoc41ace92012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000237namespace {
238/// If we have a 'templated' declaration for a template, adjust 'D' to
239/// refer to the actual template.
Dmitri Gribenko2125c902012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000240/// If we have an implicit instantiation, adjust 'D' to refer to template.
Dmitri Gribenkoc41ace92012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000241const Decl *adjustDeclToTemplate(const Decl *D) {
Douglas Gregorcd81df22012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000242 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko2125c902012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000243 // Is this function declaration part of a function template?
Douglas Gregorcd81df22012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000244 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
Dmitri Gribenko2125c902012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000245 return FTD;
246
247 // Nothing to do if function is not an implicit instantiation.
248 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
249 return D;
250
251 // Function is an implicit instantiation of a function template?
252 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getPrimaryTemplate())
253 return FTD;
254
255 // Function is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
256 if (const FunctionDecl *MemberDecl =
257 FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction())
258 return MemberDecl;
259
260 return D;
Douglas Gregorcd81df22012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000261 }
Dmitri Gribenko2125c902012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000262 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
263 // Static data member is instantiated from a member definition of a class
264 // template?
265 if (VD->isStaticDataMember())
266 if (const VarDecl *MemberDecl = VD->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember())
267 return MemberDecl;
268
269 return D;
270 }
271 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
272 // Is this class declaration part of a class template?
273 if (const ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = CRD->getDescribedClassTemplate())
274 return CTD;
275
276 // Class is an implicit instantiation of a class template or partial
277 // specialization?
278 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
279 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(CRD)) {
280 if (CTSD->getSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
281 return D;
282 llvm::PointerUnion<ClassTemplateDecl *,
283 ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>
284 PU = CTSD->getSpecializedTemplateOrPartial();
285 return PU.is<ClassTemplateDecl*>() ?
286 static_cast<const Decl*>(PU.get<ClassTemplateDecl *>()) :
287 static_cast<const Decl*>(
288 PU.get<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>());
289 }
290
291 // Class is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
292 if (const MemberSpecializationInfo *Info =
293 CRD->getMemberSpecializationInfo())
294 return Info->getInstantiatedFrom();
295
296 return D;
297 }
298 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
299 // Enum is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
300 if (const EnumDecl *MemberDecl = ED->getInstantiatedFromMemberEnum())
301 return MemberDecl;
302
303 return D;
304 }
305 // FIXME: Adjust alias templates?
Dmitri Gribenkoc41ace92012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000306 return D;
307}
308} // unnamed namespace
309
Dmitri Gribenko1599eac2012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000310const RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(
311 const Decl *D,
312 const Decl **OriginalDecl) const {
Dmitri Gribenkoc41ace92012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000313 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Douglas Gregorcd81df22012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000314
Dmitri Gribenkof50555e2012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000315 // Check whether we have cached a comment for this declaration already.
316 {
317 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
318 RedeclComments.find(D);
319 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
320 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
Dmitri Gribenko1599eac2012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000321 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
322 if (OriginalDecl)
323 *OriginalDecl = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkof50555e2012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000324 return Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko1599eac2012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000325 }
Dmitri Gribenkof50555e2012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000326 }
Dmitri Gribenko8d3ba232012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000327 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaa0cd852012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000328
Dmitri Gribenkof50555e2012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000329 // Search for comments attached to declarations in the redeclaration chain.
330 const RawComment *RC = NULL;
Dmitri Gribenko1599eac2012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000331 const Decl *OriginalDeclForRC = NULL;
Dmitri Gribenkof50555e2012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000332 for (Decl::redecl_iterator I = D->redecls_begin(),
333 E = D->redecls_end();
334 I != E; ++I) {
335 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
336 RedeclComments.find(*I);
337 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
338 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
339 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
340 RC = Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko1599eac2012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000341 OriginalDeclForRC = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkof50555e2012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000342 break;
343 }
344 } else {
345 RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(*I);
Dmitri Gribenko1599eac2012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000346 OriginalDeclForRC = *I;
Dmitri Gribenkof50555e2012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000347 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
348 if (RC) {
349 Raw.setRaw(RC);
350 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromDecl);
351 } else
352 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl);
Dmitri Gribenko1599eac2012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000353 Raw.setOriginalDecl(*I);
Dmitri Gribenkof50555e2012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000354 RedeclComments[*I] = Raw;
355 if (RC)
356 break;
357 }
358 }
359
Dmitri Gribenko8376f592012-06-28 16:25:36 +0000360 // If we found a comment, it should be a documentation comment.
361 assert(!RC || RC->isDocumentation());
Dmitri Gribenkof50555e2012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000362
Dmitri Gribenko1599eac2012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000363 if (OriginalDecl)
364 *OriginalDecl = OriginalDeclForRC;
365
Dmitri Gribenkof50555e2012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000366 // Update cache for every declaration in the redeclaration chain.
367 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
368 Raw.setRaw(RC);
369 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromRedecl);
Dmitri Gribenko1599eac2012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000370 Raw.setOriginalDecl(OriginalDeclForRC);
Dmitri Gribenkof50555e2012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000371
372 for (Decl::redecl_iterator I = D->redecls_begin(),
373 E = D->redecls_end();
374 I != E; ++I) {
375 RawCommentAndCacheFlags &R = RedeclComments[*I];
376 if (R.getKind() == RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl)
377 R = Raw;
378 }
379
Dmitri Gribenkoaa0cd852012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000380 return RC;
381}
382
Fariborz Jahanianbf967be2012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000383static void addRedeclaredMethods(const ObjCMethodDecl *ObjCMethod,
384 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Redeclared) {
385 const DeclContext *DC = ObjCMethod->getDeclContext();
386 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD = dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(DC)) {
387 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = IMD->getClassInterface();
388 if (!ID)
389 return;
390 // Add redeclared method here.
Douglas Gregord3297242013-01-16 23:00:23 +0000391 for (ObjCInterfaceDecl::known_extensions_iterator
392 Ext = ID->known_extensions_begin(),
393 ExtEnd = ID->known_extensions_end();
394 Ext != ExtEnd; ++Ext) {
Fariborz Jahanianbf967be2012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000395 if (ObjCMethodDecl *RedeclaredMethod =
Douglas Gregord3297242013-01-16 23:00:23 +0000396 Ext->getMethod(ObjCMethod->getSelector(),
Fariborz Jahanianbf967be2012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000397 ObjCMethod->isInstanceMethod()))
398 Redeclared.push_back(RedeclaredMethod);
399 }
400 }
401}
402
Fariborz Jahanian749ace62012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000403comments::FullComment *ASTContext::cloneFullComment(comments::FullComment *FC,
404 const Decl *D) const {
405 comments::DeclInfo *ThisDeclInfo = new (*this) comments::DeclInfo;
406 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = D;
407 ThisDeclInfo->IsFilled = false;
408 ThisDeclInfo->fill();
409 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = FC->getDecl();
410 comments::FullComment *CFC =
411 new (*this) comments::FullComment(FC->getBlocks(),
412 ThisDeclInfo);
413 return CFC;
414
415}
416
Richard Smith0a74a4c2013-05-21 05:24:00 +0000417comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getLocalCommentForDeclUncached(const Decl *D) const {
418 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(D);
419 return RC ? RC->parse(*this, 0, D) : 0;
420}
421
Dmitri Gribenko19523542012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000422comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getCommentForDecl(
423 const Decl *D,
424 const Preprocessor *PP) const {
Fariborz Jahanianfbff0c42013-05-13 17:27:00 +0000425 if (D->isInvalidDecl())
426 return NULL;
Dmitri Gribenkoc41ace92012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000427 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Fariborz Jahanianbf967be2012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000428
Dmitri Gribenkoc41ace92012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000429 const Decl *Canonical = D->getCanonicalDecl();
430 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, comments::FullComment *>::iterator Pos =
431 ParsedComments.find(Canonical);
Fariborz Jahanianbf967be2012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000432
433 if (Pos != ParsedComments.end()) {
Fariborz Jahanian749ace62012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000434 if (Canonical != D) {
Fariborz Jahanianbf967be2012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000435 comments::FullComment *FC = Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian749ace62012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000436 comments::FullComment *CFC = cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanianbf967be2012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000437 return CFC;
438 }
Dmitri Gribenkoc41ace92012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000439 return Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanianbf967be2012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000440 }
441
Dmitri Gribenko1599eac2012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000442 const Decl *OriginalDecl;
Fariborz Jahanianbf967be2012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000443
Dmitri Gribenko1599eac2012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000444 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(D, &OriginalDecl);
Fariborz Jahanianbf967be2012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000445 if (!RC) {
446 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko1e905da2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000447 SmallVector<const NamedDecl*, 8> Overridden;
Fariborz Jahanianc328d9c2013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000448 const ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanian23799e32013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000449 if (OMD && OMD->isPropertyAccessor())
450 if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = OMD->findPropertyDecl())
451 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(PDecl, PP))
452 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanianc328d9c2013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000453 if (OMD)
Dmitri Gribenko1e905da2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000454 addRedeclaredMethods(OMD, Overridden);
455 getOverriddenMethods(dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(D), Overridden);
Fariborz Jahanian23799e32013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000456 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Overridden.size(); i < e; i++)
457 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(Overridden[i], PP))
458 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanianbf967be2012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000459 }
Fariborz Jahanian4857fdc2013-05-02 15:44:16 +0000460 else if (const TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenkod1e5c0d2013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000461 // Attach any tag type's documentation to its typedef if latter
Fariborz Jahanian23799e32013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000462 // does not have one of its own.
Fariborz Jahanian41170b52013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000463 QualType QT = TD->getUnderlyingType();
Dmitri Gribenkod1e5c0d2013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000464 if (const TagType *TT = QT->getAs<TagType>())
465 if (const Decl *TD = TT->getDecl())
466 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(TD, PP))
Fariborz Jahanian23799e32013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000467 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian41170b52013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000468 }
Fariborz Jahanian622bb4a2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000469 else if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
470 while (IC->getSuperClass()) {
471 IC = IC->getSuperClass();
472 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
473 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
474 }
475 }
476 else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(D)) {
477 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = CD->getClassInterface())
478 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
479 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
480 }
481 else if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
482 if (!(RD = RD->getDefinition()))
483 return NULL;
484 // Check non-virtual bases.
485 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_const_iterator I =
486 RD->bases_begin(), E = RD->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanian91efca02013-04-26 23:34:36 +0000487 if (I->isVirtual() || (I->getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public))
Fariborz Jahanian622bb4a2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000488 continue;
489 QualType Ty = I->getType();
490 if (Ty.isNull())
491 continue;
492 if (const CXXRecordDecl *NonVirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
493 if (!(NonVirtualBase= NonVirtualBase->getDefinition()))
494 continue;
495
496 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((NonVirtualBase), PP))
497 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
498 }
499 }
500 // Check virtual bases.
501 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_const_iterator I =
502 RD->vbases_begin(), E = RD->vbases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanian91efca02013-04-26 23:34:36 +0000503 if (I->getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public)
504 continue;
Fariborz Jahanian622bb4a2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000505 QualType Ty = I->getType();
506 if (Ty.isNull())
507 continue;
508 if (const CXXRecordDecl *VirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
509 if (!(VirtualBase= VirtualBase->getDefinition()))
510 continue;
511 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((VirtualBase), PP))
512 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
513 }
514 }
515 }
Dmitri Gribenko8d3ba232012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000516 return NULL;
Fariborz Jahanianbf967be2012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000517 }
518
Dmitri Gribenko4b41c652012-08-22 18:12:19 +0000519 // If the RawComment was attached to other redeclaration of this Decl, we
520 // should parse the comment in context of that other Decl. This is important
521 // because comments can contain references to parameter names which can be
522 // different across redeclarations.
Dmitri Gribenko1599eac2012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000523 if (D != OriginalDecl)
Dmitri Gribenko19523542012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000524 return getCommentForDecl(OriginalDecl, PP);
Dmitri Gribenko1599eac2012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000525
Dmitri Gribenko19523542012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000526 comments::FullComment *FC = RC->parse(*this, PP, D);
Dmitri Gribenkoc41ace92012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000527 ParsedComments[Canonical] = FC;
528 return FC;
Dmitri Gribenko8d3ba232012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000529}
530
Douglas Gregor3e1274f2010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000531void
532ASTContext::CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID,
533 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Parm) {
534 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getDepth());
535 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getPosition());
Douglas Gregor61c4d282011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000536 ID.AddBoolean(Parm->isParameterPack());
Douglas Gregor3e1274f2010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000537
538 TemplateParameterList *Params = Parm->getTemplateParameters();
539 ID.AddInteger(Params->size());
540 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
541 PEnd = Params->end();
542 P != PEnd; ++P) {
543 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P)) {
544 ID.AddInteger(0);
545 ID.AddBoolean(TTP->isParameterPack());
546 continue;
547 }
548
549 if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
550 ID.AddInteger(1);
Douglas Gregor61c4d282011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000551 ID.AddBoolean(NTTP->isParameterPack());
Eli Friedman9e9c4542012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000552 ID.AddPointer(NTTP->getType().getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
Douglas Gregor6952f1e2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000553 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
554 ID.AddBoolean(true);
555 ID.AddInteger(NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes());
Eli Friedman9e9c4542012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000556 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
557 QualType T = NTTP->getExpansionType(I);
558 ID.AddPointer(T.getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
559 }
Douglas Gregor6952f1e2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000560 } else
561 ID.AddBoolean(false);
Douglas Gregor3e1274f2010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000562 continue;
563 }
564
565 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P);
566 ID.AddInteger(2);
567 Profile(ID, TTP);
568 }
569}
570
571TemplateTemplateParmDecl *
572ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +0000573 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP) const {
Douglas Gregor3e1274f2010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000574 // Check if we already have a canonical template template parameter.
575 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
576 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(ID, TTP);
577 void *InsertPos = 0;
578 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm *Canonical
579 = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
580 if (Canonical)
581 return Canonical->getParam();
582
583 // Build a canonical template parameter list.
584 TemplateParameterList *Params = TTP->getTemplateParameters();
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000585 SmallVector<NamedDecl *, 4> CanonParams;
Douglas Gregor3e1274f2010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000586 CanonParams.reserve(Params->size());
587 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
588 PEnd = Params->end();
589 P != PEnd; ++P) {
590 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P))
591 CanonParams.push_back(
592 TemplateTypeParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnara344577e2011-03-06 15:48:19 +0000593 SourceLocation(),
594 SourceLocation(),
595 TTP->getDepth(),
Douglas Gregor3e1274f2010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000596 TTP->getIndex(), 0, false,
597 TTP->isParameterPack()));
598 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
Douglas Gregor6952f1e2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000599 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
600 QualType T = getCanonicalType(NTTP->getType());
601 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
602 NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *Param;
603 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000604 SmallVector<QualType, 2> ExpandedTypes;
605 SmallVector<TypeSourceInfo *, 2> ExpandedTInfos;
Douglas Gregor6952f1e2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000606 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
607 ExpandedTypes.push_back(getCanonicalType(NTTP->getExpansionType(I)));
608 ExpandedTInfos.push_back(
609 getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ExpandedTypes.back()));
610 }
611
612 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaraff676cb2011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000613 SourceLocation(),
614 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor6952f1e2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000615 NTTP->getDepth(),
616 NTTP->getPosition(), 0,
617 T,
618 TInfo,
619 ExpandedTypes.data(),
620 ExpandedTypes.size(),
621 ExpandedTInfos.data());
622 } else {
623 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaraff676cb2011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000624 SourceLocation(),
625 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor6952f1e2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000626 NTTP->getDepth(),
627 NTTP->getPosition(), 0,
628 T,
629 NTTP->isParameterPack(),
630 TInfo);
631 }
632 CanonParams.push_back(Param);
633
634 } else
Douglas Gregor3e1274f2010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000635 CanonParams.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
636 cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P)));
637 }
638
639 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *CanonTTP
640 = TemplateTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
641 SourceLocation(), TTP->getDepth(),
Douglas Gregor61c4d282011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000642 TTP->getPosition(),
643 TTP->isParameterPack(),
644 0,
Douglas Gregor3e1274f2010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000645 TemplateParameterList::Create(*this, SourceLocation(),
646 SourceLocation(),
647 CanonParams.data(),
648 CanonParams.size(),
649 SourceLocation()));
650
651 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
652 Canonical = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
653 assert(Canonical == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
654 (void)Canonical;
655
656 // Create the canonical template template parameter entry.
657 Canonical = new (*this) CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm(CanonTTP);
658 CanonTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(Canonical, InsertPos);
659 return CanonTTP;
660}
661
Charles Davis071cc7d2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000662CXXABI *ASTContext::createCXXABI(const TargetInfo &T) {
John McCallee79a4c2010-08-21 22:46:04 +0000663 if (!LangOpts.CPlusPlus) return 0;
664
John McCallb8b2c9d2013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000665 switch (T.getCXXABI().getKind()) {
666 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM:
667 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
John McCallee79a4c2010-08-21 22:46:04 +0000668 return CreateARMCXXABI(*this);
Tim Northoverc264e162013-01-31 12:13:10 +0000669 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64: // Same as Itanium at this level
John McCallb8b2c9d2013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000670 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
Charles Davis071cc7d2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000671 return CreateItaniumCXXABI(*this);
John McCallb8b2c9d2013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000672 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Charles Davis20cf7172010-08-19 02:18:14 +0000673 return CreateMicrosoftCXXABI(*this);
674 }
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +0000675 llvm_unreachable("Invalid CXXABI type!");
Charles Davis071cc7d2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000676}
677
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000678static const LangAS::Map *getAddressSpaceMap(const TargetInfo &T,
Peter Collingbourne207f4d82011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000679 const LangOptions &LOpts) {
680 if (LOpts.FakeAddressSpaceMap) {
681 // The fake address space map must have a distinct entry for each
682 // language-specific address space.
683 static const unsigned FakeAddrSpaceMap[] = {
684 1, // opencl_global
685 2, // opencl_local
Peter Collingbourne4dc34eb2012-05-20 21:08:35 +0000686 3, // opencl_constant
687 4, // cuda_device
688 5, // cuda_constant
689 6 // cuda_shared
Peter Collingbourne207f4d82011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000690 };
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000691 return &FakeAddrSpaceMap;
Peter Collingbourne207f4d82011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000692 } else {
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000693 return &T.getAddressSpaceMap();
Peter Collingbourne207f4d82011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000694 }
695}
696
Douglas Gregor3e3cd932011-09-01 20:23:19 +0000697ASTContext::ASTContext(LangOptions& LOpts, SourceManager &SM,
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000698 const TargetInfo *t,
Daniel Dunbare91593e2008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000699 IdentifierTable &idents, SelectorTable &sels,
Chris Lattner1b63e4f2009-06-14 01:54:56 +0000700 Builtin::Context &builtins,
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000701 unsigned size_reserve,
702 bool DelayInitialization)
703 : FunctionProtoTypes(this_()),
704 TemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
705 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
706 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks(this_()),
707 GlobalNestedNameSpecifier(0),
Nico Webercac18ad2013-06-20 21:44:55 +0000708 Int128Decl(0), UInt128Decl(0), Float128StubDecl(0),
Meador Ingec5613b22012-06-16 03:34:49 +0000709 BuiltinVaListDecl(0),
Douglas Gregora6ea10e2012-01-17 18:09:05 +0000710 ObjCIdDecl(0), ObjCSelDecl(0), ObjCClassDecl(0), ObjCProtocolClassDecl(0),
Fariborz Jahanian96171302012-08-30 18:49:41 +0000711 BOOLDecl(0),
Douglas Gregore97179c2011-09-08 01:46:34 +0000712 CFConstantStringTypeDecl(0), ObjCInstanceTypeDecl(0),
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000713 FILEDecl(0),
Rafael Espindolae2d4f4e2011-11-13 21:51:09 +0000714 jmp_bufDecl(0), sigjmp_bufDecl(0), ucontext_tDecl(0),
715 BlockDescriptorType(0), BlockDescriptorExtendedType(0),
716 cudaConfigureCallDecl(0),
Douglas Gregore6649772011-12-03 00:30:27 +0000717 NullTypeSourceInfo(QualType()),
718 FirstLocalImport(), LastLocalImport(),
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000719 SourceMgr(SM), LangOpts(LOpts),
Douglas Gregor30c42402011-09-27 22:38:19 +0000720 AddrSpaceMap(0), Target(t), PrintingPolicy(LOpts),
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000721 Idents(idents), Selectors(sels),
722 BuiltinInfo(builtins),
723 DeclarationNames(*this),
Douglas Gregor30c42402011-09-27 22:38:19 +0000724 ExternalSource(0), Listener(0),
Dmitri Gribenkoaa0cd852012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000725 Comments(SM), CommentsLoaded(false),
Dmitri Gribenko6ebf0912013-02-22 14:21:27 +0000726 CommentCommandTraits(BumpAlloc, LOpts.CommentOpts),
Rafael Espindola42b78612013-05-29 19:51:12 +0000727 LastSDM(0, 0)
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000728{
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000729 if (size_reserve > 0) Types.reserve(size_reserve);
Daniel Dunbare91593e2008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000730 TUDecl = TranslationUnitDecl::Create(*this);
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000731
732 if (!DelayInitialization) {
733 assert(t && "No target supplied for ASTContext initialization");
734 InitBuiltinTypes(*t);
735 }
Daniel Dunbare91593e2008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000736}
737
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000738ASTContext::~ASTContext() {
Ted Kremenek3478eb62010-02-11 07:12:28 +0000739 // Release the DenseMaps associated with DeclContext objects.
740 // FIXME: Is this the ideal solution?
741 ReleaseDeclContextMaps();
Douglas Gregor7d10b7e2010-03-02 23:58:15 +0000742
Manuel Klimekf0f353b2013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000743 // Call all of the deallocation functions on all of their targets.
744 for (DeallocationMap::const_iterator I = Deallocations.begin(),
745 E = Deallocations.end(); I != E; ++I)
746 for (unsigned J = 0, N = I->second.size(); J != N; ++J)
747 (I->first)((I->second)[J]);
748
Ted Kremenekdcfcfbe2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000749 // ASTRecordLayout objects in ASTRecordLayouts must always be destroyed
Douglas Gregor63fe86b2010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000750 // because they can contain DenseMaps.
751 for (llvm::DenseMap<const ObjCContainerDecl*,
752 const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
753 I = ObjCLayouts.begin(), E = ObjCLayouts.end(); I != E; )
754 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
755 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
756 R->Destroy(*this);
757
Ted Kremenekdcfcfbe2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000758 for (llvm::DenseMap<const RecordDecl*, const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
759 I = ASTRecordLayouts.begin(), E = ASTRecordLayouts.end(); I != E; ) {
760 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
761 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
762 R->Destroy(*this);
763 }
Douglas Gregor63200642010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000764
765 for (llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator A = DeclAttrs.begin(),
766 AEnd = DeclAttrs.end();
767 A != AEnd; ++A)
768 A->second->~AttrVec();
769}
Douglas Gregorab452ba2009-03-26 23:50:42 +0000770
Douglas Gregor00545312010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000771void ASTContext::AddDeallocation(void (*Callback)(void*), void *Data) {
Manuel Klimekf0f353b2013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000772 Deallocations[Callback].push_back(Data);
Douglas Gregor00545312010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000773}
774
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000775void
Dylan Noblesmith6f42b622012-02-05 02:12:40 +0000776ASTContext::setExternalSource(OwningPtr<ExternalASTSource> &Source) {
Douglas Gregor2cf26342009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000777 ExternalSource.reset(Source.take());
778}
779
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000780void ASTContext::PrintStats() const {
Chandler Carruthcd92a652011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000781 llvm::errs() << "\n*** AST Context Stats:\n";
782 llvm::errs() << " " << Types.size() << " types total.\n";
Sebastian Redl7c80bd62009-03-16 23:22:08 +0000783
Douglas Gregordbe833d2009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000784 unsigned counts[] = {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000785#define TYPE(Name, Parent) 0,
Douglas Gregordbe833d2009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000786#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
787#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
788 0 // Extra
789 };
Douglas Gregorc2ee10d2009-04-07 17:20:56 +0000790
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000791 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Types.size(); i != e; ++i) {
792 Type *T = Types[i];
Douglas Gregordbe833d2009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000793 counts[(unsigned)T->getTypeClass()]++;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000794 }
795
Douglas Gregordbe833d2009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000796 unsigned Idx = 0;
797 unsigned TotalBytes = 0;
798#define TYPE(Name, Parent) \
799 if (counts[Idx]) \
Chandler Carruthcd92a652011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000800 llvm::errs() << " " << counts[Idx] << " " << #Name \
801 << " types\n"; \
Douglas Gregordbe833d2009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000802 TotalBytes += counts[Idx] * sizeof(Name##Type); \
803 ++Idx;
804#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
805#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000806
Chandler Carruthcd92a652011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000807 llvm::errs() << "Total bytes = " << TotalBytes << "\n";
808
Douglas Gregor4923aa22010-07-02 20:37:36 +0000809 // Implicit special member functions.
Chandler Carruthcd92a652011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000810 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared << "/"
811 << NumImplicitDefaultConstructors
812 << " implicit default constructors created\n";
813 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared << "/"
814 << NumImplicitCopyConstructors
815 << " implicit copy constructors created\n";
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000816 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruthcd92a652011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000817 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared << "/"
818 << NumImplicitMoveConstructors
819 << " implicit move constructors created\n";
820 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
821 << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators
822 << " implicit copy assignment operators created\n";
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000823 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruthcd92a652011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000824 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
825 << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators
826 << " implicit move assignment operators created\n";
827 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared << "/"
828 << NumImplicitDestructors
829 << " implicit destructors created\n";
830
Douglas Gregor2cf26342009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000831 if (ExternalSource.get()) {
Chandler Carruthcd92a652011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000832 llvm::errs() << "\n";
Douglas Gregor2cf26342009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000833 ExternalSource->PrintStats();
834 }
Chandler Carruthcd92a652011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000835
Douglas Gregor63fe86b2010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000836 BumpAlloc.PrintStats();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000837}
838
Douglas Gregor772eeae2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000839TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getInt128Decl() const {
840 if (!Int128Decl) {
841 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(Int128Ty);
842 Int128Decl = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this),
843 getTranslationUnitDecl(),
844 SourceLocation(),
845 SourceLocation(),
846 &Idents.get("__int128_t"),
847 TInfo);
848 }
849
850 return Int128Decl;
851}
852
853TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getUInt128Decl() const {
854 if (!UInt128Decl) {
855 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnsignedInt128Ty);
856 UInt128Decl = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this),
857 getTranslationUnitDecl(),
858 SourceLocation(),
859 SourceLocation(),
860 &Idents.get("__uint128_t"),
861 TInfo);
862 }
863
864 return UInt128Decl;
865}
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000866
Nico Webercac18ad2013-06-20 21:44:55 +0000867TypeDecl *ASTContext::getFloat128StubType() const {
Nico Weber3f7c1b12013-06-21 01:29:36 +0000868 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus && "should only be called for c++");
Nico Webercac18ad2013-06-20 21:44:55 +0000869 if (!Float128StubDecl) {
Nico Weber9b9bdba2013-06-20 23:30:30 +0000870 Float128StubDecl = CXXRecordDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this),
871 TTK_Struct,
872 getTranslationUnitDecl(),
873 SourceLocation(),
874 SourceLocation(),
875 &Idents.get("__float128"));
Nico Webercac18ad2013-06-20 21:44:55 +0000876 }
877
878 return Float128StubDecl;
879}
880
John McCalle27ec8a2009-10-23 23:03:21 +0000881void ASTContext::InitBuiltinType(CanQualType &R, BuiltinType::Kind K) {
John McCall6b304a02009-09-24 23:30:46 +0000882 BuiltinType *Ty = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BuiltinType(K);
John McCalle27ec8a2009-10-23 23:03:21 +0000883 R = CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(QualType(Ty, 0));
John McCall6b304a02009-09-24 23:30:46 +0000884 Types.push_back(Ty);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000885}
886
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000887void ASTContext::InitBuiltinTypes(const TargetInfo &Target) {
888 assert((!this->Target || this->Target == &Target) &&
889 "Incorrect target reinitialization");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000890 assert(VoidTy.isNull() && "Context reinitialized?");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000891
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000892 this->Target = &Target;
893
894 ABI.reset(createCXXABI(Target));
895 AddrSpaceMap = getAddressSpaceMap(Target, LangOpts);
896
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000897 // C99 6.2.5p19.
898 InitBuiltinType(VoidTy, BuiltinType::Void);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000899
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000900 // C99 6.2.5p2.
901 InitBuiltinType(BoolTy, BuiltinType::Bool);
902 // C99 6.2.5p3.
Eli Friedman15b91762009-06-05 07:05:05 +0000903 if (LangOpts.CharIsSigned)
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000904 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_S);
905 else
906 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_U);
907 // C99 6.2.5p4.
908 InitBuiltinType(SignedCharTy, BuiltinType::SChar);
909 InitBuiltinType(ShortTy, BuiltinType::Short);
910 InitBuiltinType(IntTy, BuiltinType::Int);
911 InitBuiltinType(LongTy, BuiltinType::Long);
912 InitBuiltinType(LongLongTy, BuiltinType::LongLong);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000913
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000914 // C99 6.2.5p6.
915 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedCharTy, BuiltinType::UChar);
916 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedShortTy, BuiltinType::UShort);
917 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedIntTy, BuiltinType::UInt);
918 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongTy, BuiltinType::ULong);
919 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongLongTy, BuiltinType::ULongLong);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000920
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000921 // C99 6.2.5p10.
922 InitBuiltinType(FloatTy, BuiltinType::Float);
923 InitBuiltinType(DoubleTy, BuiltinType::Double);
924 InitBuiltinType(LongDoubleTy, BuiltinType::LongDouble);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64c438a2008-08-09 16:51:54 +0000925
Chris Lattner2df9ced2009-04-30 02:43:43 +0000926 // GNU extension, 128-bit integers.
927 InitBuiltinType(Int128Ty, BuiltinType::Int128);
928 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedInt128Ty, BuiltinType::UInt128);
929
Hans Wennborg15f92ba2013-05-10 10:08:40 +0000930 // C++ 3.9.1p5
931 if (TargetInfo::isTypeSigned(Target.getWCharType()))
932 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_S);
933 else // -fshort-wchar makes wchar_t be unsigned.
934 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_U);
935 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && LangOpts.WChar)
936 WideCharTy = WCharTy;
937 else {
938 // C99 (or C++ using -fno-wchar).
939 WideCharTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWCharType());
940 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64c438a2008-08-09 16:51:54 +0000941
James Molloy392da482012-05-04 10:55:22 +0000942 WIntTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWIntType());
943
Alisdair Meredithf5c209d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +0000944 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
945 InitBuiltinType(Char16Ty, BuiltinType::Char16);
946 else // C99
947 Char16Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar16Type());
948
949 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
950 InitBuiltinType(Char32Ty, BuiltinType::Char32);
951 else // C99
952 Char32Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar32Type());
953
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +0000954 // Placeholder type for type-dependent expressions whose type is
955 // completely unknown. No code should ever check a type against
956 // DependentTy and users should never see it; however, it is here to
957 // help diagnose failures to properly check for type-dependent
958 // expressions.
959 InitBuiltinType(DependentTy, BuiltinType::Dependent);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000960
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +0000961 // Placeholder type for functions.
962 InitBuiltinType(OverloadTy, BuiltinType::Overload);
963
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +0000964 // Placeholder type for bound members.
965 InitBuiltinType(BoundMemberTy, BuiltinType::BoundMember);
966
John McCall3c3b7f92011-10-25 17:37:35 +0000967 // Placeholder type for pseudo-objects.
968 InitBuiltinType(PseudoObjectTy, BuiltinType::PseudoObject);
969
John McCall1de4d4e2011-04-07 08:22:57 +0000970 // "any" type; useful for debugger-like clients.
971 InitBuiltinType(UnknownAnyTy, BuiltinType::UnknownAny);
972
John McCall0ddaeb92011-10-17 18:09:15 +0000973 // Placeholder type for unbridged ARC casts.
974 InitBuiltinType(ARCUnbridgedCastTy, BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast);
975
Eli Friedmana6c66ce2012-08-31 00:14:07 +0000976 // Placeholder type for builtin functions.
977 InitBuiltinType(BuiltinFnTy, BuiltinType::BuiltinFn);
978
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000979 // C99 6.2.5p11.
980 FloatComplexTy = getComplexType(FloatTy);
981 DoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(DoubleTy);
982 LongDoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(LongDoubleTy);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000983
Fariborz Jahanian13dcd002009-11-21 19:53:08 +0000984 // Builtin types for 'id', 'Class', and 'SEL'.
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +0000985 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, BuiltinType::ObjCId);
986 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, BuiltinType::ObjCClass);
Fariborz Jahanian13dcd002009-11-21 19:53:08 +0000987 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy, BuiltinType::ObjCSel);
Guy Benyeib13621d2012-12-18 14:38:23 +0000988
989 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) {
990 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1d);
991 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray);
992 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dBufferTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer);
993 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2d);
994 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray);
995 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage3dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage3d);
Guy Benyeie6b9d802013-01-20 12:31:11 +0000996
Guy Benyei21f18c42013-02-07 10:55:47 +0000997 InitBuiltinType(OCLSamplerTy, BuiltinType::OCLSampler);
Guy Benyeie6b9d802013-01-20 12:31:11 +0000998 InitBuiltinType(OCLEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLEvent);
Guy Benyeib13621d2012-12-18 14:38:23 +0000999 }
Ted Kremenekebcb57a2012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001000
1001 // Builtin type for __objc_yes and __objc_no
Fariborz Jahanian93a49942012-04-16 21:03:30 +00001002 ObjCBuiltinBoolTy = (Target.useSignedCharForObjCBool() ?
1003 SignedCharTy : BoolTy);
Ted Kremenekebcb57a2012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001004
Ted Kremeneka526c5c2008-01-07 19:49:32 +00001005 ObjCConstantStringType = QualType();
Fariborz Jahanianf7992132013-01-04 18:45:40 +00001006
1007 ObjCSuperType = QualType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001008
Fariborz Jahanian33e1d642007-10-29 22:57:28 +00001009 // void * type
1010 VoidPtrTy = getPointerType(VoidTy);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001011
1012 // nullptr type (C++0x 2.14.7)
1013 InitBuiltinType(NullPtrTy, BuiltinType::NullPtr);
Anton Korobeynikovaa4a99b2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001014
1015 // half type (OpenCL 6.1.1.1) / ARM NEON __fp16
1016 InitBuiltinType(HalfTy, BuiltinType::Half);
Meador Ingefb40e3f2012-07-01 15:57:25 +00001017
1018 // Builtin type used to help define __builtin_va_list.
1019 VaListTagTy = QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001020}
1021
David Blaikied6471f72011-09-25 23:23:43 +00001022DiagnosticsEngine &ASTContext::getDiagnostics() const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis78a916e2010-09-22 14:32:24 +00001023 return SourceMgr.getDiagnostics();
1024}
1025
Douglas Gregor63200642010-08-30 16:49:28 +00001026AttrVec& ASTContext::getDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1027 AttrVec *&Result = DeclAttrs[D];
1028 if (!Result) {
1029 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(AttrVec));
1030 Result = new (Mem) AttrVec;
1031 }
1032
1033 return *Result;
1034}
1035
1036/// \brief Erase the attributes corresponding to the given declaration.
1037void ASTContext::eraseDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1038 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator Pos = DeclAttrs.find(D);
1039 if (Pos != DeclAttrs.end()) {
1040 Pos->second->~AttrVec();
1041 DeclAttrs.erase(Pos);
1042 }
1043}
1044
Larisse Voufoef4579c2013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001045// FIXME: Remove ?
Douglas Gregor251b4ff2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001046MemberSpecializationInfo *
Douglas Gregor663b5a02009-10-14 20:14:33 +00001047ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(const VarDecl *Var) {
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001048 assert(Var->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufoef4579c2013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001049 return getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Var)
1050 .dyn_cast<MemberSpecializationInfo *>();
1051}
1052
1053ASTContext::TemplateOrSpecializationInfo
1054ASTContext::getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(const VarDecl *Var) {
1055 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, TemplateOrSpecializationInfo>::iterator Pos =
1056 TemplateOrInstantiation.find(Var);
1057 if (Pos == TemplateOrInstantiation.end())
1058 return TemplateOrSpecializationInfo();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001059
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001060 return Pos->second;
1061}
1062
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001063void
Douglas Gregor251b4ff2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001064ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(VarDecl *Inst, VarDecl *Tmpl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9421adc2010-07-04 21:44:00 +00001065 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK,
1066 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation) {
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001067 assert(Inst->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1068 assert(Tmpl->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufoef4579c2013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001069 setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Inst, new (*this) MemberSpecializationInfo(
1070 Tmpl, TSK, PointOfInstantiation));
1071}
1072
1073void
1074ASTContext::setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(VarDecl *Inst,
1075 TemplateOrSpecializationInfo TSI) {
1076 assert(!TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] &&
1077 "Already noted what the variable was instantiated from");
1078 TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] = TSI;
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001079}
1080
Francois Pichetaf0f4d02011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001081FunctionDecl *ASTContext::getClassScopeSpecializationPattern(
1082 const FunctionDecl *FD){
1083 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1084 llvm::DenseMap<const FunctionDecl*, FunctionDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
Francois Pichet0d95f0d2011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001085 = ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.find(FD);
1086 if (Pos == ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.end())
Francois Pichetaf0f4d02011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001087 return 0;
1088
1089 return Pos->second;
1090}
1091
1092void ASTContext::setClassScopeSpecializationPattern(FunctionDecl *FD,
1093 FunctionDecl *Pattern) {
1094 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1095 assert(Pattern && "Class scope specialization pattern is 0");
Francois Pichet0d95f0d2011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001096 ClassScopeSpecializationPattern[FD] = Pattern;
Francois Pichetaf0f4d02011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001097}
1098
John McCall7ba107a2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001099NamedDecl *
John McCalled976492009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001100ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *UUD) {
John McCall7ba107a2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001101 llvm::DenseMap<UsingDecl *, NamedDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
John McCalled976492009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001102 = InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.find(UUD);
1103 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.end())
Anders Carlsson0d8df782009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001104 return 0;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001105
Anders Carlsson0d8df782009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001106 return Pos->second;
1107}
1108
1109void
John McCalled976492009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001110ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *Inst, NamedDecl *Pattern) {
1111 assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Pattern) ||
1112 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Pattern) ||
1113 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Pattern)) &&
1114 "pattern decl is not a using decl");
1115 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1116 InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
1117}
1118
1119UsingShadowDecl *
1120ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst) {
1121 llvm::DenseMap<UsingShadowDecl*, UsingShadowDecl*>::const_iterator Pos
1122 = InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.find(Inst);
1123 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.end())
1124 return 0;
1125
1126 return Pos->second;
1127}
1128
1129void
1130ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst,
1131 UsingShadowDecl *Pattern) {
1132 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1133 InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
Anders Carlsson0d8df782009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001134}
1135
Anders Carlssond8b285f2009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001136FieldDecl *ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Field) {
1137 llvm::DenseMap<FieldDecl *, FieldDecl *>::iterator Pos
1138 = InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.find(Field);
1139 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.end())
1140 return 0;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001141
Anders Carlssond8b285f2009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001142 return Pos->second;
1143}
1144
1145void ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Inst,
1146 FieldDecl *Tmpl) {
1147 assert(!Inst->getDeclName() && "Instantiated field decl is not unnamed");
1148 assert(!Tmpl->getDeclName() && "Template field decl is not unnamed");
1149 assert(!InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] &&
1150 "Already noted what unnamed field was instantiated from");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001151
Anders Carlssond8b285f2009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001152 InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] = Tmpl;
1153}
1154
Douglas Gregor7d10b7e2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001155ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1156ASTContext::overridden_methods_begin(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1157 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidis38eb1e12012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001158 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor7d10b7e2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001159 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1160 return 0;
1161
1162 return Pos->second.begin();
1163}
1164
1165ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1166ASTContext::overridden_methods_end(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1167 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidis38eb1e12012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001168 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor7d10b7e2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001169 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1170 return 0;
1171
1172 return Pos->second.end();
1173}
1174
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc91e9f42010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001175unsigned
1176ASTContext::overridden_methods_size(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1177 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidis38eb1e12012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001178 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc91e9f42010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001179 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1180 return 0;
1181
1182 return Pos->second.size();
1183}
1184
Douglas Gregor7d10b7e2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001185void ASTContext::addOverriddenMethod(const CXXMethodDecl *Method,
1186 const CXXMethodDecl *Overridden) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis38eb1e12012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001187 assert(Method->isCanonicalDecl() && Overridden->isCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor7d10b7e2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001188 OverriddenMethods[Method].push_back(Overridden);
1189}
1190
Dmitri Gribenko1e905da2012-11-03 14:24:57 +00001191void ASTContext::getOverriddenMethods(
1192 const NamedDecl *D,
1193 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Overridden) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis21c36072012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001194 assert(D);
1195
1196 if (const CXXMethodDecl *CXXMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis685d1042013-04-17 00:09:03 +00001197 Overridden.append(overridden_methods_begin(CXXMethod),
1198 overridden_methods_end(CXXMethod));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis21c36072012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001199 return;
1200 }
1201
1202 const ObjCMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
1203 if (!Method)
1204 return;
1205
Argyrios Kyrtzidis740ae672012-10-09 18:19:01 +00001206 SmallVector<const ObjCMethodDecl *, 8> OverDecls;
1207 Method->getOverriddenMethods(OverDecls);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisbc0a2bb2012-10-09 20:08:43 +00001208 Overridden.append(OverDecls.begin(), OverDecls.end());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis21c36072012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001209}
1210
Douglas Gregore6649772011-12-03 00:30:27 +00001211void ASTContext::addedLocalImportDecl(ImportDecl *Import) {
1212 assert(!Import->NextLocalImport && "Import declaration already in the chain");
1213 assert(!Import->isFromASTFile() && "Non-local import declaration");
1214 if (!FirstLocalImport) {
1215 FirstLocalImport = Import;
1216 LastLocalImport = Import;
1217 return;
1218 }
1219
1220 LastLocalImport->NextLocalImport = Import;
1221 LastLocalImport = Import;
1222}
1223
Chris Lattner464175b2007-07-18 17:52:12 +00001224//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1225// Type Sizing and Analysis
1226//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattnera7674d82007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001227
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001228/// getFloatTypeSemantics - Return the APFloat 'semantics' for the specified
1229/// scalar floating point type.
1230const llvm::fltSemantics &ASTContext::getFloatTypeSemantics(QualType T) const {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001231 const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001232 assert(BT && "Not a floating point type!");
1233 switch (BT->getKind()) {
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001234 default: llvm_unreachable("Not a floating point type!");
Anton Korobeynikovaa4a99b2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001235 case BuiltinType::Half: return Target->getHalfFormat();
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001236 case BuiltinType::Float: return Target->getFloatFormat();
1237 case BuiltinType::Double: return Target->getDoubleFormat();
1238 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return Target->getLongDoubleFormat();
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001239 }
1240}
1241
Rafael Espindola1c56c9d2013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001242CharUnits ASTContext::getDeclAlign(const Decl *D, bool ForAlignof) const {
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001243 unsigned Align = Target->getCharWidth();
Eli Friedmandcdafb62009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001244
John McCall4081a5c2010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001245 bool UseAlignAttrOnly = false;
1246 if (unsigned AlignFromAttr = D->getMaxAlignment()) {
1247 Align = AlignFromAttr;
Eli Friedmandcdafb62009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001248
John McCall4081a5c2010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001249 // __attribute__((aligned)) can increase or decrease alignment
1250 // *except* on a struct or struct member, where it only increases
1251 // alignment unless 'packed' is also specified.
1252 //
Peter Collingbourne82d0b0a2011-09-29 18:04:28 +00001253 // It is an error for alignas to decrease alignment, so we can
John McCall4081a5c2010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001254 // ignore that possibility; Sema should diagnose it.
1255 if (isa<FieldDecl>(D)) {
1256 UseAlignAttrOnly = D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1257 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
1258 } else {
1259 UseAlignAttrOnly = true;
1260 }
1261 }
Fariborz Jahanian78a7d7d2011-05-05 21:19:14 +00001262 else if (isa<FieldDecl>(D))
1263 UseAlignAttrOnly =
1264 D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1265 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
John McCall4081a5c2010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001266
John McCallba4f5d52011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001267 // If we're using the align attribute only, just ignore everything
1268 // else about the declaration and its type.
John McCall4081a5c2010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001269 if (UseAlignAttrOnly) {
John McCallba4f5d52011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001270 // do nothing
1271
John McCall4081a5c2010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001272 } else if (const ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D)) {
Chris Lattneraf707ab2009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001273 QualType T = VD->getType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001274 if (const ReferenceType* RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Rafael Espindola1c56c9d2013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001275 if (ForAlignof)
Sebastian Redl5d484e82009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001276 T = RT->getPointeeType();
1277 else
1278 T = getPointerType(RT->getPointeeType());
1279 }
1280 if (!T->isIncompleteType() && !T->isFunctionType()) {
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001281 // Adjust alignments of declarations with array type by the
1282 // large-array alignment on the target.
Rafael Espindolab82f77f2013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001283 if (const ArrayType *arrayType = getAsArrayType(T)) {
Rafael Espindola1c56c9d2013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001284 unsigned MinWidth = Target->getLargeArrayMinWidth();
1285 if (!ForAlignof && MinWidth) {
Rafael Espindolab82f77f2013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001286 if (isa<VariableArrayType>(arrayType))
1287 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1288 else if (isa<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType) &&
1289 MinWidth <= getTypeSize(cast<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType)))
1290 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1291 }
Eli Friedmandcdafb62009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001292
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001293 // Walk through any array types while we're at it.
1294 T = getBaseElementType(arrayType);
1295 }
Chad Rosier9f1210c2011-07-26 07:03:04 +00001296 Align = std::max(Align, getPreferredTypeAlign(T.getTypePtr()));
Ulrich Weigand6b203512013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001297 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
1298 if (VD->hasGlobalStorage())
1299 Align = std::max(Align, getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1300 }
Eli Friedmandcdafb62009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001301 }
John McCallba4f5d52011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001302
1303 // Fields can be subject to extra alignment constraints, like if
1304 // the field is packed, the struct is packed, or the struct has a
1305 // a max-field-alignment constraint (#pragma pack). So calculate
1306 // the actual alignment of the field within the struct, and then
1307 // (as we're expected to) constrain that by the alignment of the type.
Matt Beaumont-Gay147fab92013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001308 if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) {
1309 const RecordDecl *Parent = Field->getParent();
1310 // We can only produce a sensible answer if the record is valid.
1311 if (!Parent->isInvalidDecl()) {
1312 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(Parent);
John McCallba4f5d52011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001313
Matt Beaumont-Gay147fab92013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001314 // Start with the record's overall alignment.
1315 unsigned FieldAlign = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
John McCallba4f5d52011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001316
Matt Beaumont-Gay147fab92013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001317 // Use the GCD of that and the offset within the record.
1318 uint64_t Offset = Layout.getFieldOffset(Field->getFieldIndex());
1319 if (Offset > 0) {
1320 // Alignment is always a power of 2, so the GCD will be a power of 2,
1321 // which means we get to do this crazy thing instead of Euclid's.
1322 uint64_t LowBitOfOffset = Offset & (~Offset + 1);
1323 if (LowBitOfOffset < FieldAlign)
1324 FieldAlign = static_cast<unsigned>(LowBitOfOffset);
1325 }
1326
1327 Align = std::min(Align, FieldAlign);
John McCallba4f5d52011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001328 }
Charles Davis05f62472010-02-23 04:52:00 +00001329 }
Chris Lattneraf707ab2009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001330 }
Eli Friedmandcdafb62009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001331
Ken Dyckeb6f5dc2011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001332 return toCharUnitsFromBits(Align);
Chris Lattneraf707ab2009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001333}
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001334
John McCall929bbfb2012-08-21 04:10:00 +00001335// getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars - Return the size of a type, in
1336// chars. If the type is a record, its data size is returned. This is
1337// the size of the memcpy that's performed when assigning this type
1338// using a trivial copy/move assignment operator.
1339std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1340ASTContext::getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
1341 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> sizeAndAlign = getTypeInfoInChars(T);
1342
1343 // In C++, objects can sometimes be allocated into the tail padding
1344 // of a base-class subobject. We decide whether that's possible
1345 // during class layout, so here we can just trust the layout results.
1346 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
1347 if (const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>()) {
1348 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
1349 sizeAndAlign.first = layout.getDataSize();
1350 }
1351 }
1352
1353 return sizeAndAlign;
1354}
1355
Richard Trieu910f17e2013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001356/// getConstantArrayInfoInChars - Performing the computation in CharUnits
1357/// instead of in bits prevents overflowing the uint64_t for some large arrays.
1358std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1359static getConstantArrayInfoInChars(const ASTContext &Context,
1360 const ConstantArrayType *CAT) {
1361 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> EltInfo =
1362 Context.getTypeInfoInChars(CAT->getElementType());
1363 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Trieu1069b732013-05-14 23:41:50 +00001364 assert((Size == 0 || static_cast<uint64_t>(EltInfo.first.getQuantity()) <=
1365 (uint64_t)(-1)/Size) &&
Richard Trieu910f17e2013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001366 "Overflow in array type char size evaluation");
1367 uint64_t Width = EltInfo.first.getQuantity() * Size;
1368 unsigned Align = EltInfo.second.getQuantity();
1369 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
1370 return std::make_pair(CharUnits::fromQuantity(Width),
1371 CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align));
1372}
1373
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001374std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckbee5a792011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001375ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu910f17e2013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001376 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(T))
1377 return getConstantArrayInfoInChars(*this, CAT);
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001378 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> Info = getTypeInfo(T);
Ken Dyckeb6f5dc2011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001379 return std::make_pair(toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.first),
1380 toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.second));
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001381}
1382
1383std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckbee5a792011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001384ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(QualType T) const {
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001385 return getTypeInfoInChars(T.getTypePtr());
1386}
1387
Daniel Dunbarbc5419a2012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001388std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> ASTContext::getTypeInfo(const Type *T) const {
1389 TypeInfoMap::iterator it = MemoizedTypeInfo.find(T);
1390 if (it != MemoizedTypeInfo.end())
1391 return it->second;
1392
1393 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> Info = getTypeInfoImpl(T);
1394 MemoizedTypeInfo.insert(std::make_pair(T, Info));
1395 return Info;
1396}
1397
1398/// getTypeInfoImpl - Return the size of the specified type, in bits. This
1399/// method does not work on incomplete types.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001400///
1401/// FIXME: Pointers into different addr spaces could have different sizes and
1402/// alignment requirements: getPointerInfo should take an AddrSpace, this
1403/// should take a QualType, &c.
Chris Lattnerd2d2a112007-07-14 01:29:45 +00001404std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned>
Daniel Dunbarbc5419a2012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001405ASTContext::getTypeInfoImpl(const Type *T) const {
Mike Stump5e301002009-02-27 18:32:39 +00001406 uint64_t Width=0;
1407 unsigned Align=8;
Chris Lattnera7674d82007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001408 switch (T->getTypeClass()) {
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001409#define TYPE(Class, Base)
1410#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregor18857642009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001411#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001412#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
David Blaikiedc809782013-07-13 21:08:03 +00001413#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) \
1414 case Type::Class: \
1415 assert(!T->isDependentType() && "should not see dependent types here"); \
1416 return getTypeInfo(cast<Class##Type>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001417#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
John McCalld3d49bb2011-06-28 16:49:23 +00001418 llvm_unreachable("Should not see dependent types");
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001419
Chris Lattner692233e2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001420 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
1421 case Type::FunctionProto:
Douglas Gregor18857642009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001422 // GCC extension: alignof(function) = 32 bits
1423 Width = 0;
1424 Align = 32;
1425 break;
1426
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001427 case Type::IncompleteArray:
Steve Narofffb22d962007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001428 case Type::VariableArray:
Douglas Gregor18857642009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001429 Width = 0;
1430 Align = getTypeAlign(cast<ArrayType>(T)->getElementType());
1431 break;
1432
Steve Narofffb22d962007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001433 case Type::ConstantArray: {
Daniel Dunbar1d751182008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001434 const ConstantArrayType *CAT = cast<ConstantArrayType>(T);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001435
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001436 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> EltInfo = getTypeInfo(CAT->getElementType());
Abramo Bagnarafea966a2011-12-13 11:23:52 +00001437 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
Daniel Dunbarbc5419a2012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001438 assert((Size == 0 || EltInfo.first <= (uint64_t)(-1)/Size) &&
1439 "Overflow in array type bit size evaluation");
Abramo Bagnarafea966a2011-12-13 11:23:52 +00001440 Width = EltInfo.first*Size;
Chris Lattner030d8842007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001441 Align = EltInfo.second;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscd88b412011-04-26 21:05:39 +00001442 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
Chris Lattner030d8842007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001443 break;
Christopher Lamb5c09a022007-12-29 05:10:55 +00001444 }
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00001445 case Type::ExtVector:
Chris Lattner030d8842007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001446 case Type::Vector: {
Chris Lattner9fcfe922009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001447 const VectorType *VT = cast<VectorType>(T);
1448 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> EltInfo = getTypeInfo(VT->getElementType());
1449 Width = EltInfo.first*VT->getNumElements();
Eli Friedman4bd998b2008-05-30 09:31:38 +00001450 Align = Width;
Nate Begeman6fe7c8a2009-01-18 06:42:49 +00001451 // If the alignment is not a power of 2, round up to the next power of 2.
1452 // This happens for non-power-of-2 length vectors.
Dan Gohman8eefcd32010-04-21 23:32:43 +00001453 if (Align & (Align-1)) {
Chris Lattner9fcfe922009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001454 Align = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Align);
1455 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
1456 }
Chad Rosierf9e9af72012-07-13 23:57:43 +00001457 // Adjust the alignment based on the target max.
1458 uint64_t TargetVectorAlign = Target->getMaxVectorAlign();
1459 if (TargetVectorAlign && TargetVectorAlign < Align)
1460 Align = TargetVectorAlign;
Chris Lattner030d8842007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001461 break;
1462 }
Chris Lattner5d2a6302007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001463
Chris Lattner9e9b6dc2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001464 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattnera7674d82007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001465 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001466 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type!");
Chris Lattnerd2d2a112007-07-14 01:29:45 +00001467 case BuiltinType::Void:
Douglas Gregor18857642009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001468 // GCC extension: alignof(void) = 8 bits.
1469 Width = 0;
1470 Align = 8;
1471 break;
1472
Chris Lattner6f62c2a2007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001473 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001474 Width = Target->getBoolWidth();
1475 Align = Target->getBoolAlign();
Chris Lattner6f62c2a2007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001476 break;
Chris Lattner692233e2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001477 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
1478 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
1479 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Chris Lattner6f62c2a2007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001480 case BuiltinType::SChar:
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001481 Width = Target->getCharWidth();
1482 Align = Target->getCharAlign();
Chris Lattner6f62c2a2007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001483 break;
Chris Lattner3f59c972010-12-25 23:25:43 +00001484 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
1485 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001486 Width = Target->getWCharWidth();
1487 Align = Target->getWCharAlign();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64c438a2008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001488 break;
Alisdair Meredithf5c209d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001489 case BuiltinType::Char16:
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001490 Width = Target->getChar16Width();
1491 Align = Target->getChar16Align();
Alisdair Meredithf5c209d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001492 break;
1493 case BuiltinType::Char32:
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001494 Width = Target->getChar32Width();
1495 Align = Target->getChar32Align();
Alisdair Meredithf5c209d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001496 break;
Chris Lattner692233e2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001497 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Chris Lattner6f62c2a2007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001498 case BuiltinType::Short:
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001499 Width = Target->getShortWidth();
1500 Align = Target->getShortAlign();
Chris Lattner6f62c2a2007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001501 break;
Chris Lattner692233e2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001502 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Chris Lattner6f62c2a2007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001503 case BuiltinType::Int:
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001504 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1505 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
Chris Lattner6f62c2a2007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001506 break;
Chris Lattner692233e2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001507 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Chris Lattner6f62c2a2007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001508 case BuiltinType::Long:
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001509 Width = Target->getLongWidth();
1510 Align = Target->getLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6f62c2a2007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001511 break;
Chris Lattner692233e2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001512 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Chris Lattner6f62c2a2007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001513 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001514 Width = Target->getLongLongWidth();
1515 Align = Target->getLongLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6f62c2a2007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001516 break;
Chris Lattnerec16cb92009-04-30 02:55:13 +00001517 case BuiltinType::Int128:
1518 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
1519 Width = 128;
1520 Align = 128; // int128_t is 128-bit aligned on all targets.
1521 break;
Anton Korobeynikovaa4a99b2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001522 case BuiltinType::Half:
1523 Width = Target->getHalfWidth();
1524 Align = Target->getHalfAlign();
1525 break;
Chris Lattner6f62c2a2007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001526 case BuiltinType::Float:
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001527 Width = Target->getFloatWidth();
1528 Align = Target->getFloatAlign();
Chris Lattner6f62c2a2007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001529 break;
1530 case BuiltinType::Double:
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001531 Width = Target->getDoubleWidth();
1532 Align = Target->getDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6f62c2a2007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001533 break;
1534 case BuiltinType::LongDouble:
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001535 Width = Target->getLongDoubleWidth();
1536 Align = Target->getLongDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6f62c2a2007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001537 break;
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001538 case BuiltinType::NullPtr:
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001539 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0); // C++ 3.9.1p11: sizeof(nullptr_t)
1540 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0); // == sizeof(void*)
Sebastian Redl1590d9c2009-05-27 19:34:06 +00001541 break;
Fariborz Jahaniane04f5fc2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001542 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
1543 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
1544 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001545 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1546 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Fariborz Jahaniane04f5fc2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001547 break;
Guy Benyei21f18c42013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001548 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
1549 // Samplers are modeled as integers.
1550 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1551 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
1552 break;
Guy Benyeie6b9d802013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001553 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Guy Benyeib13621d2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001554 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d:
1555 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray:
1556 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer:
1557 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d:
1558 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray:
1559 case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d:
1560 // Currently these types are pointers to opaque types.
1561 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1562 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
1563 break;
Chris Lattnera7674d82007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001564 }
Chris Lattnerbfef6d72007-07-15 23:46:53 +00001565 break;
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00001566 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001567 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1568 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Chris Lattner6f62c2a2007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001569 break;
Steve Naroff485eeff2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001570 case Type::BlockPointer: {
Peter Collingbourne207f4d82011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001571 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1572 cast<BlockPointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001573 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1574 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Steve Naroff485eeff2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001575 break;
1576 }
Sebastian Redl5d484e82009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001577 case Type::LValueReference:
1578 case Type::RValueReference: {
1579 // alignof and sizeof should never enter this code path here, so we go
1580 // the pointer route.
Peter Collingbourne207f4d82011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001581 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1582 cast<ReferenceType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001583 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1584 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Sebastian Redl5d484e82009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001585 break;
1586 }
Chris Lattnerf72a4432008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001587 case Type::Pointer: {
Peter Collingbourne207f4d82011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001588 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<PointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001589 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1590 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Chris Lattnerf72a4432008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001591 break;
1592 }
Sebastian Redlf30208a2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001593 case Type::MemberPointer: {
Charles Davis071cc7d2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00001594 const MemberPointerType *MPT = cast<MemberPointerType>(T);
Reid Kleckner84e9ab42013-03-28 20:02:56 +00001595 llvm::tie(Width, Align) = ABI->getMemberPointerWidthAndAlign(MPT);
Anders Carlsson1cca74e2009-05-17 02:06:04 +00001596 break;
Sebastian Redlf30208a2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001597 }
Chris Lattner5d2a6302007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001598 case Type::Complex: {
1599 // Complex types have the same alignment as their elements, but twice the
1600 // size.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001601 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> EltInfo =
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001602 getTypeInfo(cast<ComplexType>(T)->getElementType());
Chris Lattner9e9b6dc2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001603 Width = EltInfo.first*2;
Chris Lattner5d2a6302007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001604 Align = EltInfo.second;
1605 break;
1606 }
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00001607 case Type::ObjCObject:
1608 return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCObjectType>(T)->getBaseType().getTypePtr());
Reid Kleckner12df2462013-06-24 17:51:48 +00001609 case Type::Decayed:
1610 return getTypeInfo(cast<DecayedType>(T)->getDecayedType().getTypePtr());
Devang Patel44a3dde2008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001611 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
Daniel Dunbar1d751182008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001612 const ObjCInterfaceType *ObjCI = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(T);
Devang Patel44a3dde2008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001613 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(ObjCI->getDecl());
Ken Dyckdd76a9a2011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001614 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyckdac54c12011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001615 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
Devang Patel44a3dde2008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001616 break;
1617 }
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001618 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001619 case Type::Enum: {
Daniel Dunbar1d751182008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001620 const TagType *TT = cast<TagType>(T);
1621
1622 if (TT->getDecl()->isInvalidDecl()) {
Douglas Gregor22ce41d2011-04-20 17:29:44 +00001623 Width = 8;
1624 Align = 8;
Chris Lattner8389eab2008-08-09 21:35:13 +00001625 break;
1626 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001627
Daniel Dunbar1d751182008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001628 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(TT))
Chris Lattner71763312008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001629 return getTypeInfo(ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType());
1630
Daniel Dunbar1d751182008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001631 const RecordType *RT = cast<RecordType>(TT);
Chris Lattner71763312008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001632 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
Ken Dyckdd76a9a2011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001633 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyckdac54c12011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001634 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerdc0d73e2007-07-23 22:46:22 +00001635 break;
Chris Lattnera7674d82007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001636 }
Douglas Gregor7532dc62009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001637
Chris Lattner9fcfe922009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001638 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm:
John McCall49a832b2009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001639 return getTypeInfo(cast<SubstTemplateTypeParmType>(T)->
1640 getReplacementType().getTypePtr());
John McCall49a832b2009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001641
Richard Smith34b41d92011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001642 case Type::Auto: {
1643 const AutoType *A = cast<AutoType>(T);
Richard Smithdc7a4f52013-04-30 13:56:41 +00001644 assert(!A->getDeducedType().isNull() &&
1645 "cannot request the size of an undeduced or dependent auto type");
Matt Beaumont-Gaydc856af2011-02-22 20:00:16 +00001646 return getTypeInfo(A->getDeducedType().getTypePtr());
Richard Smith34b41d92011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001647 }
1648
Abramo Bagnara075f8f12010-12-10 16:29:40 +00001649 case Type::Paren:
1650 return getTypeInfo(cast<ParenType>(T)->getInnerType().getTypePtr());
1651
Douglas Gregor18857642009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001652 case Type::Typedef: {
Richard Smith162e1c12011-04-15 14:24:37 +00001653 const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = cast<TypedefType>(T)->getDecl();
Douglas Gregordf1367a2010-08-27 00:11:28 +00001654 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> Info
1655 = getTypeInfo(Typedef->getUnderlyingType().getTypePtr());
Chris Lattnerc1de52d2011-02-19 22:55:41 +00001656 // If the typedef has an aligned attribute on it, it overrides any computed
1657 // alignment we have. This violates the GCC documentation (which says that
1658 // attribute(aligned) can only round up) but matches its implementation.
1659 if (unsigned AttrAlign = Typedef->getMaxAlignment())
1660 Align = AttrAlign;
1661 else
1662 Align = Info.second;
Douglas Gregordf1367a2010-08-27 00:11:28 +00001663 Width = Info.first;
Douglas Gregor7532dc62009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001664 break;
Chris Lattner71763312008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001665 }
Douglas Gregor18857642009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001666
Abramo Bagnara465d41b2010-05-11 21:36:43 +00001667 case Type::Elaborated:
1668 return getTypeInfo(cast<ElaboratedType>(T)->getNamedType().getTypePtr());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001669
John McCall9d156a72011-01-06 01:58:22 +00001670 case Type::Attributed:
1671 return getTypeInfo(
1672 cast<AttributedType>(T)->getEquivalentType().getTypePtr());
1673
Eli Friedmanb001de72011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001674 case Type::Atomic: {
John McCall9eda3ab2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001675 // Start with the base type information.
Eli Friedman2be46072011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001676 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> Info
1677 = getTypeInfo(cast<AtomicType>(T)->getValueType());
1678 Width = Info.first;
1679 Align = Info.second;
John McCall9eda3ab2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001680
1681 // If the size of the type doesn't exceed the platform's max
1682 // atomic promotion width, make the size and alignment more
1683 // favorable to atomic operations:
1684 if (Width != 0 && Width <= Target->getMaxAtomicPromoteWidth()) {
1685 // Round the size up to a power of 2.
1686 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width))
1687 Width = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Width);
1688
1689 // Set the alignment equal to the size.
Eli Friedman2be46072011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001690 Align = static_cast<unsigned>(Width);
1691 }
Eli Friedmanb001de72011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001692 }
1693
Douglas Gregor18857642009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001694 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001695
Eli Friedman2be46072011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001696 assert(llvm::isPowerOf2_32(Align) && "Alignment must be power of 2");
Chris Lattner9e9b6dc2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001697 return std::make_pair(Width, Align);
Chris Lattnera7674d82007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001698}
1699
Ken Dyckeb6f5dc2011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001700/// toCharUnitsFromBits - Convert a size in bits to a size in characters.
1701CharUnits ASTContext::toCharUnitsFromBits(int64_t BitSize) const {
1702 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(BitSize / getCharWidth());
1703}
1704
Ken Dyckdd76a9a2011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001705/// toBits - Convert a size in characters to a size in characters.
1706int64_t ASTContext::toBits(CharUnits CharSize) const {
1707 return CharSize.getQuantity() * getCharWidth();
1708}
1709
Ken Dyckbdc601b2009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001710/// getTypeSizeInChars - Return the size of the specified type, in characters.
1711/// This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001712CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
Richard Trieu910f17e2013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001713 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyckbdc601b2009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001714}
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001715CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu910f17e2013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001716 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyckbdc601b2009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001717}
1718
Ken Dyck16e20cc2010-01-26 17:25:18 +00001719/// getTypeAlignInChars - Return the ABI-specified alignment of a type, in
Ken Dyck86fa4312010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001720/// characters. This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001721CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(QualType T) const {
Ken Dyckeb6f5dc2011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001722 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck86fa4312010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001723}
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001724CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(const Type *T) const {
Ken Dyckeb6f5dc2011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001725 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck86fa4312010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001726}
1727
Chris Lattner34ebde42009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001728/// getPreferredTypeAlign - Return the "preferred" alignment of the specified
1729/// type for the current target in bits. This can be different than the ABI
1730/// alignment in cases where it is beneficial for performance to overalign
1731/// a data type.
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001732unsigned ASTContext::getPreferredTypeAlign(const Type *T) const {
Chris Lattner34ebde42009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001733 unsigned ABIAlign = getTypeAlign(T);
Eli Friedman1eed6022009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001734
1735 // Double and long long should be naturally aligned if possible.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001736 if (const ComplexType* CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Eli Friedman1eed6022009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001737 T = CT->getElementType().getTypePtr();
1738 if (T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double) ||
Chad Rosiercde7a1d2012-03-21 20:20:47 +00001739 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongLong) ||
1740 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULongLong))
Eli Friedman1eed6022009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001741 return std::max(ABIAlign, (unsigned)getTypeSize(T));
1742
Chris Lattner34ebde42009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001743 return ABIAlign;
1744}
1745
Ulrich Weigand6b203512013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001746/// getAlignOfGlobalVar - Return the alignment in bits that should be given
1747/// to a global variable of the specified type.
1748unsigned ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVar(QualType T) const {
1749 return std::max(getTypeAlign(T), getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1750}
1751
1752/// getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars - Return the alignment in characters that
1753/// should be given to a global variable of the specified type.
1754CharUnits ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars(QualType T) const {
1755 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getAlignOfGlobalVar(T));
1756}
1757
Fariborz Jahanian2c18bb72010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001758/// DeepCollectObjCIvars -
1759/// This routine first collects all declared, but not synthesized, ivars in
1760/// super class and then collects all ivars, including those synthesized for
1761/// current class. This routine is used for implementation of current class
1762/// when all ivars, declared and synthesized are known.
Fariborz Jahanian98200742009-05-12 18:14:29 +00001763///
Fariborz Jahanian2c18bb72010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001764void ASTContext::DeepCollectObjCIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI,
1765 bool leafClass,
Jordy Rosedb8264e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00001766 SmallVectorImpl<const ObjCIvarDecl*> &Ivars) const {
Fariborz Jahanian2c18bb72010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001767 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *SuperClass = OI->getSuperClass())
1768 DeepCollectObjCIvars(SuperClass, false, Ivars);
1769 if (!leafClass) {
1770 for (ObjCInterfaceDecl::ivar_iterator I = OI->ivar_begin(),
1771 E = OI->ivar_end(); I != E; ++I)
David Blaikie581deb32012-06-06 20:45:41 +00001772 Ivars.push_back(*I);
Chad Rosier30601782011-08-17 23:08:45 +00001773 } else {
Fariborz Jahanianbf9eb882011-06-28 18:05:25 +00001774 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = const_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl *>(OI);
Jordy Rosedb8264e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00001775 for (const ObjCIvarDecl *Iv = IDecl->all_declared_ivar_begin(); Iv;
Fariborz Jahanianbf9eb882011-06-28 18:05:25 +00001776 Iv= Iv->getNextIvar())
1777 Ivars.push_back(Iv);
1778 }
Fariborz Jahanian98200742009-05-12 18:14:29 +00001779}
1780
Fariborz Jahaniane23fa2d2009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001781/// CollectInheritedProtocols - Collect all protocols in current class and
1782/// those inherited by it.
1783void ASTContext::CollectInheritedProtocols(const Decl *CDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian432a8892010-02-12 19:27:33 +00001784 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> &Protocols) {
Fariborz Jahaniane23fa2d2009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001785 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CDecl)) {
Ted Kremenek53b94412010-09-01 01:21:15 +00001786 // We can use protocol_iterator here instead of
1787 // all_referenced_protocol_iterator since we are walking all categories.
1788 for (ObjCInterfaceDecl::all_protocol_iterator P = OI->all_referenced_protocol_begin(),
1789 PE = OI->all_referenced_protocol_end(); P != PE; ++P) {
Fariborz Jahaniane23fa2d2009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001790 ObjCProtocolDecl *Proto = (*P);
Douglas Gregor3fc73ee2012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001791 Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
Fariborz Jahaniane23fa2d2009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001792 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator P = Proto->protocol_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanianb2f81212010-02-25 18:24:33 +00001793 PE = Proto->protocol_end(); P != PE; ++P) {
Douglas Gregor3fc73ee2012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001794 Protocols.insert((*P)->getCanonicalDecl());
Fariborz Jahaniane23fa2d2009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001795 CollectInheritedProtocols(*P, Protocols);
1796 }
Fariborz Jahanianb2f81212010-02-25 18:24:33 +00001797 }
Fariborz Jahaniane23fa2d2009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001798
1799 // Categories of this Interface.
Douglas Gregord3297242013-01-16 23:00:23 +00001800 for (ObjCInterfaceDecl::visible_categories_iterator
1801 Cat = OI->visible_categories_begin(),
1802 CatEnd = OI->visible_categories_end();
1803 Cat != CatEnd; ++Cat) {
1804 CollectInheritedProtocols(*Cat, Protocols);
1805 }
1806
Fariborz Jahaniane23fa2d2009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001807 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *SD = OI->getSuperClass())
1808 while (SD) {
1809 CollectInheritedProtocols(SD, Protocols);
1810 SD = SD->getSuperClass();
1811 }
Benjamin Kramerb170ca52010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001812 } else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *OC = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CDecl)) {
Ted Kremenek53b94412010-09-01 01:21:15 +00001813 for (ObjCCategoryDecl::protocol_iterator P = OC->protocol_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniane23fa2d2009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001814 PE = OC->protocol_end(); P != PE; ++P) {
1815 ObjCProtocolDecl *Proto = (*P);
Douglas Gregor3fc73ee2012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001816 Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
Fariborz Jahaniane23fa2d2009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001817 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator P = Proto->protocol_begin(),
1818 PE = Proto->protocol_end(); P != PE; ++P)
1819 CollectInheritedProtocols(*P, Protocols);
1820 }
Benjamin Kramerb170ca52010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001821 } else if (const ObjCProtocolDecl *OP = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl>(CDecl)) {
Fariborz Jahaniane23fa2d2009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001822 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator P = OP->protocol_begin(),
1823 PE = OP->protocol_end(); P != PE; ++P) {
1824 ObjCProtocolDecl *Proto = (*P);
Douglas Gregor3fc73ee2012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001825 Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
Fariborz Jahaniane23fa2d2009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001826 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator P = Proto->protocol_begin(),
1827 PE = Proto->protocol_end(); P != PE; ++P)
1828 CollectInheritedProtocols(*P, Protocols);
1829 }
Fariborz Jahaniane23fa2d2009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001830 }
1831}
1832
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001833unsigned ASTContext::CountNonClassIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI) const {
Fariborz Jahanian3bfacdf2010-03-22 18:25:57 +00001834 unsigned count = 0;
1835 // Count ivars declared in class extension.
Douglas Gregord3297242013-01-16 23:00:23 +00001836 for (ObjCInterfaceDecl::known_extensions_iterator
1837 Ext = OI->known_extensions_begin(),
1838 ExtEnd = OI->known_extensions_end();
1839 Ext != ExtEnd; ++Ext) {
1840 count += Ext->ivar_size();
1841 }
1842
Fariborz Jahanian3bfacdf2010-03-22 18:25:57 +00001843 // Count ivar defined in this class's implementation. This
1844 // includes synthesized ivars.
1845 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplDecl = OI->getImplementation())
Benjamin Kramerb170ca52010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001846 count += ImplDecl->ivar_size();
1847
Fariborz Jahanian8e6ac1d2009-06-04 01:19:09 +00001848 return count;
1849}
1850
Argyrios Kyrtzidis8deabc12012-02-03 05:58:16 +00001851bool ASTContext::isSentinelNullExpr(const Expr *E) {
1852 if (!E)
1853 return false;
1854
1855 // nullptr_t is always treated as null.
1856 if (E->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return true;
1857
1858 if (E->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
1859 E->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(*this,
1860 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
1861 return true;
1862
1863 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
1864 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(E)) return true;
1865
1866 return false;
1867}
1868
Argyrios Kyrtzidis8a1d7222009-07-21 00:05:53 +00001869/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl,or NULL if none exists.
1870ObjCImplementationDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) {
1871 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
1872 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
1873 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
1874 return cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(I->second);
1875 return 0;
1876}
1877/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl, or NULL if none exists.
1878ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *D) {
1879 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
1880 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
1881 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
1882 return cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(I->second);
1883 return 0;
1884}
1885
1886/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl.
1887void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFaceD,
1888 ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplD) {
1889 assert(IFaceD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
1890 ObjCImpls[IFaceD] = ImplD;
1891}
1892/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl.
1893void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *CatD,
1894 ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ImplD) {
1895 assert(CatD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
1896 ObjCImpls[CatD] = ImplD;
1897}
1898
Dmitri Gribenkob35cc2d2013-02-03 13:23:21 +00001899const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjContainingInterface(
1900 const NamedDecl *ND) const {
1901 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID =
1902 dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidis87ec9c22011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001903 return ID;
Dmitri Gribenkob35cc2d2013-02-03 13:23:21 +00001904 if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD =
1905 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidis87ec9c22011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001906 return CD->getClassInterface();
Dmitri Gribenkob35cc2d2013-02-03 13:23:21 +00001907 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD =
1908 dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidis87ec9c22011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001909 return IMD->getClassInterface();
1910
1911 return 0;
1912}
1913
Fariborz Jahanian1ceee5c2010-12-01 22:29:46 +00001914/// \brief Get the copy initialization expression of VarDecl,or NULL if
1915/// none exists.
Fariborz Jahanian830937b2010-12-02 17:02:11 +00001916Expr *ASTContext::getBlockVarCopyInits(const VarDecl*VD) {
Fariborz Jahaniand016ec22010-12-06 17:28:17 +00001917 assert(VD && "Passed null params");
1918 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
1919 "getBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian830937b2010-12-02 17:02:11 +00001920 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl*, Expr*>::iterator
Fariborz Jahaniand016ec22010-12-06 17:28:17 +00001921 I = BlockVarCopyInits.find(VD);
Fariborz Jahanian1ceee5c2010-12-01 22:29:46 +00001922 return (I != BlockVarCopyInits.end()) ? cast<Expr>(I->second) : 0;
1923}
1924
1925/// \brief Set the copy inialization expression of a block var decl.
1926void ASTContext::setBlockVarCopyInits(VarDecl*VD, Expr* Init) {
1927 assert(VD && Init && "Passed null params");
Fariborz Jahaniand016ec22010-12-06 17:28:17 +00001928 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
1929 "setBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian1ceee5c2010-12-01 22:29:46 +00001930 BlockVarCopyInits[VD] = Init;
1931}
1932
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001933TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::CreateTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001934 unsigned DataSize) const {
John McCall109de5e2009-10-21 00:23:54 +00001935 if (!DataSize)
1936 DataSize = TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T);
1937 else
1938 assert(DataSize == TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T) &&
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001939 "incorrect data size provided to CreateTypeSourceInfo!");
John McCall109de5e2009-10-21 00:23:54 +00001940
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001941 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo =
1942 (TypeSourceInfo*)BumpAlloc.Allocate(sizeof(TypeSourceInfo) + DataSize, 8);
1943 new (TInfo) TypeSourceInfo(T);
1944 return TInfo;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb17166c2009-08-19 01:27:32 +00001945}
1946
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001947TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Douglas Gregor6952f1e2011-01-19 20:10:05 +00001948 SourceLocation L) const {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001949 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(T);
Douglas Gregorc21c7e92011-01-25 19:13:18 +00001950 DI->getTypeLoc().initialize(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), L);
John McCalla4eb74d2009-10-23 21:14:09 +00001951 return DI;
1952}
1953
Daniel Dunbarb2dbbb92009-05-03 10:38:35 +00001954const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001955ASTContext::getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) const {
Daniel Dunbarb2dbbb92009-05-03 10:38:35 +00001956 return getObjCLayout(D, 0);
1957}
1958
1959const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001960ASTContext::getASTObjCImplementationLayout(
1961 const ObjCImplementationDecl *D) const {
Daniel Dunbarb2dbbb92009-05-03 10:38:35 +00001962 return getObjCLayout(D->getClassInterface(), D);
1963}
1964
Chris Lattnera7674d82007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001965//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1966// Type creation/memoization methods
1967//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1968
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001969QualType
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001970ASTContext::getExtQualType(const Type *baseType, Qualifiers quals) const {
1971 unsigned fastQuals = quals.getFastQualifiers();
1972 quals.removeFastQualifiers();
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001973
1974 // Check if we've already instantiated this type.
1975 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001976 ExtQuals::Profile(ID, baseType, quals);
1977 void *insertPos = 0;
1978 if (ExtQuals *eq = ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos)) {
1979 assert(eq->getQualifiers() == quals);
1980 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001981 }
1982
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001983 // If the base type is not canonical, make the appropriate canonical type.
1984 QualType canon;
1985 if (!baseType->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
1986 SplitQualType canonSplit = baseType->getCanonicalTypeInternal().split();
John McCall200fa532012-02-08 00:46:36 +00001987 canonSplit.Quals.addConsistentQualifiers(quals);
1988 canon = getExtQualType(canonSplit.Ty, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001989
1990 // Re-find the insert position.
1991 (void) ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
1992 }
1993
1994 ExtQuals *eq = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ExtQuals(baseType, canon, quals);
1995 ExtQualNodes.InsertNode(eq, insertPos);
1996 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001997}
1998
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001999QualType
2000ASTContext::getAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T, unsigned AddressSpace) const {
Chris Lattnerf52ab252008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002001 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
2002 if (CanT.getAddressSpace() == AddressSpace)
Chris Lattnerf46699c2008-02-20 20:55:12 +00002003 return T;
Chris Lattnerb7d25532009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002004
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002005 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2006 // into one ExtQuals node.
2007 QualifierCollector Quals;
2008 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002009
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002010 // If this type already has an address space specified, it cannot get
2011 // another one.
2012 assert(!Quals.hasAddressSpace() &&
2013 "Type cannot be in multiple addr spaces!");
2014 Quals.addAddressSpace(AddressSpace);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002015
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002016 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Christopher Lambebb97e92008-02-04 02:31:56 +00002017}
2018
Chris Lattnerb7d25532009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002019QualType ASTContext::getObjCGCQualType(QualType T,
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002020 Qualifiers::GC GCAttr) const {
Fariborz Jahaniand33d9c02009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002021 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
Chris Lattnerb7d25532009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002022 if (CanT.getObjCGCAttr() == GCAttr)
Fariborz Jahaniand33d9c02009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002023 return T;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002024
John McCall7f040a92010-12-24 02:08:15 +00002025 if (const PointerType *ptr = T->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2026 QualType Pointee = ptr->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00002027 if (Pointee->isAnyPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian4027cd12009-06-03 17:15:17 +00002028 QualType ResultType = getObjCGCQualType(Pointee, GCAttr);
2029 return getPointerType(ResultType);
2030 }
2031 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002032
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002033 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2034 // into one ExtQuals node.
2035 QualifierCollector Quals;
2036 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002037
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002038 // If this type already has an ObjCGC specified, it cannot get
2039 // another one.
2040 assert(!Quals.hasObjCGCAttr() &&
2041 "Type cannot have multiple ObjCGCs!");
2042 Quals.addObjCGCAttr(GCAttr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002043
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002044 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Fariborz Jahaniand33d9c02009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002045}
Chris Lattnera7674d82007-07-13 22:13:22 +00002046
John McCalle6a365d2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002047const FunctionType *ASTContext::adjustFunctionType(const FunctionType *T,
2048 FunctionType::ExtInfo Info) {
2049 if (T->getExtInfo() == Info)
2050 return T;
2051
2052 QualType Result;
2053 if (const FunctionNoProtoType *FNPT = dyn_cast<FunctionNoProtoType>(T)) {
2054 Result = getFunctionNoProtoType(FNPT->getResultType(), Info);
2055 } else {
2056 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(T);
2057 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
2058 EPI.ExtInfo = Info;
Reid Kleckner0567a792013-06-10 20:51:09 +00002059 Result = getFunctionType(FPT->getResultType(), FPT->getArgTypes(), EPI);
John McCalle6a365d2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002060 }
2061
2062 return cast<FunctionType>(Result.getTypePtr());
2063}
2064
Richard Smith60e141e2013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002065void ASTContext::adjustDeducedFunctionResultType(FunctionDecl *FD,
2066 QualType ResultType) {
Richard Smith9dadfab2013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002067 FD = FD->getMostRecentDecl();
2068 while (true) {
Richard Smith60e141e2013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002069 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2070 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
2071 FD->setType(getFunctionType(ResultType, FPT->getArgTypes(), EPI));
Richard Smith9dadfab2013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002072 if (FunctionDecl *Next = FD->getPreviousDecl())
2073 FD = Next;
2074 else
2075 break;
Richard Smith60e141e2013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002076 }
Richard Smith9dadfab2013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002077 if (ASTMutationListener *L = getASTMutationListener())
2078 L->DeducedReturnType(FD, ResultType);
Richard Smith60e141e2013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002079}
2080
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002081/// getComplexType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a complex
2082/// number with the specified element type.
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002083QualType ASTContext::getComplexType(QualType T) const {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002084 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2085 // structure.
2086 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2087 ComplexType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002088
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002089 void *InsertPos = 0;
2090 if (ComplexType *CT = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2091 return QualType(CT, 0);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002092
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002093 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2094 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2095 QualType Canonical;
John McCall467b27b2009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002096 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattnerf52ab252008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002097 Canonical = getComplexType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002098
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002099 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2100 ComplexType *NewIP = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinc6ed7292010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002101 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002102 }
John McCall6b304a02009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002103 ComplexType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ComplexType(T, Canonical);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002104 Types.push_back(New);
2105 ComplexTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2106 return QualType(New, 0);
2107}
2108
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002109/// getPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a pointer to
2110/// the specified type.
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002111QualType ASTContext::getPointerType(QualType T) const {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002112 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2113 // structure.
2114 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2115 PointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002116
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002117 void *InsertPos = 0;
2118 if (PointerType *PT = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2119 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002120
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002121 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2122 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2123 QualType Canonical;
Bob Wilsonc90cc932013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002124 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattnerf52ab252008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002125 Canonical = getPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002126
Bob Wilsonc90cc932013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002127 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2128 PointerType *NewIP = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2129 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2130 }
John McCall6b304a02009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002131 PointerType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PointerType(T, Canonical);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002132 Types.push_back(New);
2133 PointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2134 return QualType(New, 0);
2135}
2136
Reid Kleckner12df2462013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002137QualType ASTContext::getDecayedType(QualType T) const {
2138 assert((T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType()) && "T does not decay");
2139
2140 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2141 DecayedType::Profile(ID, T);
2142 void *InsertPos = 0;
2143 if (DecayedType *DT = DecayedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2144 return QualType(DT, 0);
2145
2146 QualType Decayed;
2147
2148 // C99 6.7.5.3p7:
2149 // A declaration of a parameter as "array of type" shall be
2150 // adjusted to "qualified pointer to type", where the type
2151 // qualifiers (if any) are those specified within the [ and ] of
2152 // the array type derivation.
2153 if (T->isArrayType())
2154 Decayed = getArrayDecayedType(T);
2155
2156 // C99 6.7.5.3p8:
2157 // A declaration of a parameter as "function returning type"
2158 // shall be adjusted to "pointer to function returning type", as
2159 // in 6.3.2.1.
2160 if (T->isFunctionType())
2161 Decayed = getPointerType(T);
2162
2163 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decayed);
2164
2165 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2166 DecayedType *NewIP = DecayedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2167 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2168
2169 DecayedType *New =
2170 new (*this, TypeAlignment) DecayedType(T, Decayed, Canonical);
2171 Types.push_back(New);
2172 DecayedTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2173 return QualType(New, 0);
2174}
2175
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002176/// getBlockPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for
Steve Naroff5618bd42008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002177/// a pointer to the specified block.
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002178QualType ASTContext::getBlockPointerType(QualType T) const {
Steve Naroff296e8d52008-08-28 19:20:44 +00002179 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "block of function types only");
2180 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one block of a particular
Steve Naroff5618bd42008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002181 // structure.
2182 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2183 BlockPointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002184
Steve Naroff5618bd42008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002185 void *InsertPos = 0;
2186 if (BlockPointerType *PT =
2187 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2188 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002189
2190 // If the block pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
Steve Naroff5618bd42008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002191 // type either so fill in the canonical type field.
2192 QualType Canonical;
John McCall467b27b2009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002193 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Steve Naroff5618bd42008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002194 Canonical = getBlockPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002195
Steve Naroff5618bd42008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002196 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2197 BlockPointerType *NewIP =
2198 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinc6ed7292010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002199 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff5618bd42008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002200 }
John McCall6b304a02009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002201 BlockPointerType *New
2202 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BlockPointerType(T, Canonical);
Steve Naroff5618bd42008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002203 Types.push_back(New);
2204 BlockPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2205 return QualType(New, 0);
2206}
2207
Sebastian Redl7c80bd62009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002208/// getLValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2209/// lvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002210QualType
2211ASTContext::getLValueReferenceType(QualType T, bool SpelledAsLValue) const {
Douglas Gregor9625e442011-05-21 22:16:50 +00002212 assert(getCanonicalType(T) != OverloadTy &&
2213 "Unresolved overloaded function type");
2214
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002215 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2216 // structure.
2217 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall54e14c42009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002218 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, SpelledAsLValue);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002219
2220 void *InsertPos = 0;
Sebastian Redl7c80bd62009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002221 if (LValueReferenceType *RT =
2222 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002223 return QualType(RT, 0);
Sebastian Redl7c80bd62009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002224
John McCall54e14c42009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002225 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2226
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002227 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2228 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2229 QualType Canonical;
John McCall54e14c42009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002230 if (!SpelledAsLValue || InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2231 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2232 Canonical = getLValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl7c80bd62009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002233
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002234 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Sebastian Redl7c80bd62009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002235 LValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2236 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinc6ed7292010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002237 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002238 }
2239
John McCall6b304a02009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002240 LValueReferenceType *New
John McCall54e14c42009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002241 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) LValueReferenceType(T, Canonical,
2242 SpelledAsLValue);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002243 Types.push_back(New);
Sebastian Redl7c80bd62009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002244 LValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
John McCall54e14c42009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002245
Sebastian Redl7c80bd62009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002246 return QualType(New, 0);
2247}
2248
2249/// getRValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2250/// rvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002251QualType ASTContext::getRValueReferenceType(QualType T) const {
Sebastian Redl7c80bd62009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002252 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2253 // structure.
2254 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall54e14c42009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002255 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, false);
Sebastian Redl7c80bd62009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002256
2257 void *InsertPos = 0;
2258 if (RValueReferenceType *RT =
2259 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2260 return QualType(RT, 0);
2261
John McCall54e14c42009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002262 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2263
Sebastian Redl7c80bd62009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002264 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2265 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2266 QualType Canonical;
John McCall54e14c42009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002267 if (InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2268 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2269 Canonical = getRValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl7c80bd62009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002270
2271 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2272 RValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2273 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinc6ed7292010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002274 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl7c80bd62009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002275 }
2276
John McCall6b304a02009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002277 RValueReferenceType *New
2278 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RValueReferenceType(T, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl7c80bd62009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002279 Types.push_back(New);
2280 RValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002281 return QualType(New, 0);
2282}
2283
Sebastian Redlf30208a2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002284/// getMemberPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a
2285/// member pointer to the specified type, in the specified class.
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002286QualType ASTContext::getMemberPointerType(QualType T, const Type *Cls) const {
Sebastian Redlf30208a2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002287 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2288 // structure.
2289 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2290 MemberPointerType::Profile(ID, T, Cls);
2291
2292 void *InsertPos = 0;
2293 if (MemberPointerType *PT =
2294 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2295 return QualType(PT, 0);
2296
2297 // If the pointee or class type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
2298 // type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2299 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor87c12c42009-11-04 16:49:01 +00002300 if (!T.isCanonical() || !Cls->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
Sebastian Redlf30208a2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002301 Canonical = getMemberPointerType(getCanonicalType(T),getCanonicalType(Cls));
2302
2303 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2304 MemberPointerType *NewIP =
2305 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinc6ed7292010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002306 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redlf30208a2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002307 }
John McCall6b304a02009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002308 MemberPointerType *New
2309 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) MemberPointerType(T, Cls, Canonical);
Sebastian Redlf30208a2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002310 Types.push_back(New);
2311 MemberPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2312 return QualType(New, 0);
2313}
2314
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002315/// getConstantArrayType - Return the unique reference to the type for an
Steve Narofffb22d962007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002316/// array of the specified element type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002317QualType ASTContext::getConstantArrayType(QualType EltTy,
Chris Lattner38aeec72009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002318 const llvm::APInt &ArySizeIn,
Steve Naroffc9406122007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002319 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara63e7d252011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002320 unsigned IndexTypeQuals) const {
Sebastian Redl923d56d2009-11-05 15:52:31 +00002321 assert((EltTy->isDependentType() ||
2322 EltTy->isIncompleteType() || EltTy->isConstantSizeType()) &&
Eli Friedman587cbdf2009-05-29 20:17:55 +00002323 "Constant array of VLAs is illegal!");
2324
Chris Lattner38aeec72009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002325 // Convert the array size into a canonical width matching the pointer size for
2326 // the target.
2327 llvm::APInt ArySize(ArySizeIn);
Jay Foad9f71a8f2010-12-07 08:25:34 +00002328 ArySize =
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00002329 ArySize.zextOrTrunc(Target->getPointerWidth(getTargetAddressSpace(EltTy)));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002330
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002331 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara63e7d252011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002332 ConstantArrayType::Profile(ID, EltTy, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002333
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002334 void *InsertPos = 0;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002335 if (ConstantArrayType *ATP =
Ted Kremenek7192f8e2007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002336 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002337 return QualType(ATP, 0);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002338
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002339 // If the element type isn't canonical or has qualifiers, this won't
2340 // be a canonical type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2341 QualType Canon;
2342 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2343 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall200fa532012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002344 Canon = getConstantArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), ArySize,
Abramo Bagnara63e7d252011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002345 ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
John McCall200fa532012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002346 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002347
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002348 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002349 ConstantArrayType *NewIP =
Ted Kremenek7192f8e2007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002350 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinc6ed7292010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002351 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002352 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002353
John McCall6b304a02009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002354 ConstantArrayType *New = new(*this,TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara63e7d252011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002355 ConstantArrayType(EltTy, Canon, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Ted Kremenek7192f8e2007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002356 ConstantArrayTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002357 Types.push_back(New);
2358 return QualType(New, 0);
2359}
2360
John McCallce889032011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002361/// getVariableArrayDecayedType - Turns the given type, which may be
2362/// variably-modified, into the corresponding type with all the known
2363/// sizes replaced with [*].
2364QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayDecayedType(QualType type) const {
2365 // Vastly most common case.
2366 if (!type->isVariablyModifiedType()) return type;
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002367
John McCallce889032011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002368 QualType result;
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002369
John McCallce889032011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002370 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall200fa532012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002371 const Type *ty = split.Ty;
John McCallce889032011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002372 switch (ty->getTypeClass()) {
2373#define TYPE(Class, Base)
2374#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
2375#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
2376#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
2377 llvm_unreachable("didn't desugar past all non-canonical types?");
2378
2379 // These types should never be variably-modified.
2380 case Type::Builtin:
2381 case Type::Complex:
2382 case Type::Vector:
2383 case Type::ExtVector:
2384 case Type::DependentSizedExtVector:
2385 case Type::ObjCObject:
2386 case Type::ObjCInterface:
2387 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
2388 case Type::Record:
2389 case Type::Enum:
2390 case Type::UnresolvedUsing:
2391 case Type::TypeOfExpr:
2392 case Type::TypeOf:
2393 case Type::Decltype:
Sean Huntca63c202011-05-24 22:41:36 +00002394 case Type::UnaryTransform:
John McCallce889032011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002395 case Type::DependentName:
2396 case Type::InjectedClassName:
2397 case Type::TemplateSpecialization:
2398 case Type::DependentTemplateSpecialization:
2399 case Type::TemplateTypeParm:
2400 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParmPack:
Richard Smith34b41d92011-02-20 03:19:35 +00002401 case Type::Auto:
John McCallce889032011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002402 case Type::PackExpansion:
2403 llvm_unreachable("type should never be variably-modified");
2404
2405 // These types can be variably-modified but should never need to
2406 // further decay.
2407 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
2408 case Type::FunctionProto:
2409 case Type::BlockPointer:
2410 case Type::MemberPointer:
2411 return type;
2412
2413 // These types can be variably-modified. All these modifications
2414 // preserve structure except as noted by comments.
2415 // TODO: if we ever care about optimizing VLAs, there are no-op
2416 // optimizations available here.
2417 case Type::Pointer:
2418 result = getPointerType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(
2419 cast<PointerType>(ty)->getPointeeType()));
2420 break;
2421
2422 case Type::LValueReference: {
2423 const LValueReferenceType *lv = cast<LValueReferenceType>(ty);
2424 result = getLValueReferenceType(
2425 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()),
2426 lv->isSpelledAsLValue());
2427 break;
2428 }
2429
2430 case Type::RValueReference: {
2431 const RValueReferenceType *lv = cast<RValueReferenceType>(ty);
2432 result = getRValueReferenceType(
2433 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()));
2434 break;
2435 }
2436
Eli Friedmanb001de72011-10-06 23:00:33 +00002437 case Type::Atomic: {
2438 const AtomicType *at = cast<AtomicType>(ty);
2439 result = getAtomicType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(at->getValueType()));
2440 break;
2441 }
2442
John McCallce889032011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002443 case Type::ConstantArray: {
2444 const ConstantArrayType *cat = cast<ConstantArrayType>(ty);
2445 result = getConstantArrayType(
2446 getVariableArrayDecayedType(cat->getElementType()),
2447 cat->getSize(),
2448 cat->getSizeModifier(),
2449 cat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers());
2450 break;
2451 }
2452
2453 case Type::DependentSizedArray: {
2454 const DependentSizedArrayType *dat = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ty);
2455 result = getDependentSizedArrayType(
2456 getVariableArrayDecayedType(dat->getElementType()),
2457 dat->getSizeExpr(),
2458 dat->getSizeModifier(),
2459 dat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2460 dat->getBracketsRange());
2461 break;
2462 }
2463
2464 // Turn incomplete types into [*] types.
2465 case Type::IncompleteArray: {
2466 const IncompleteArrayType *iat = cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ty);
2467 result = getVariableArrayType(
2468 getVariableArrayDecayedType(iat->getElementType()),
2469 /*size*/ 0,
2470 ArrayType::Normal,
2471 iat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2472 SourceRange());
2473 break;
2474 }
2475
2476 // Turn VLA types into [*] types.
2477 case Type::VariableArray: {
2478 const VariableArrayType *vat = cast<VariableArrayType>(ty);
2479 result = getVariableArrayType(
2480 getVariableArrayDecayedType(vat->getElementType()),
2481 /*size*/ 0,
2482 ArrayType::Star,
2483 vat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2484 vat->getBracketsRange());
2485 break;
2486 }
2487 }
2488
2489 // Apply the top-level qualifiers from the original.
John McCall200fa532012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002490 return getQualifiedType(result, split.Quals);
John McCallce889032011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002491}
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002492
Steve Naroffbdbf7b02007-08-30 18:14:25 +00002493/// getVariableArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to the type for a
2494/// variable array of the specified element type.
Douglas Gregor7e7eb3d2009-07-06 15:59:29 +00002495QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayType(QualType EltTy,
2496 Expr *NumElts,
Steve Naroffc9406122007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002497 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara63e7d252011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002498 unsigned IndexTypeQuals,
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002499 SourceRange Brackets) const {
Eli Friedmanc5773c42008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002500 // Since we don't unique expressions, it isn't possible to unique VLA's
2501 // that have an expression provided for their size.
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002502 QualType Canon;
Douglas Gregor715e9c82010-05-23 16:10:32 +00002503
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002504 // Be sure to pull qualifiers off the element type.
2505 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2506 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall200fa532012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002507 Canon = getVariableArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), NumElts, ASM,
Abramo Bagnara63e7d252011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002508 IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
John McCall200fa532012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002509 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Douglas Gregor715e9c82010-05-23 16:10:32 +00002510 }
2511
John McCall6b304a02009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002512 VariableArrayType *New = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara63e7d252011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002513 VariableArrayType(EltTy, Canon, NumElts, ASM, IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
Eli Friedmanc5773c42008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002514
2515 VariableArrayTypes.push_back(New);
2516 Types.push_back(New);
2517 return QualType(New, 0);
2518}
2519
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002520/// getDependentSizedArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to
2521/// the type for a dependently-sized array of the specified element
Douglas Gregor04d4bee2009-07-31 00:23:35 +00002522/// type.
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002523QualType ASTContext::getDependentSizedArrayType(QualType elementType,
2524 Expr *numElements,
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002525 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002526 unsigned elementTypeQuals,
2527 SourceRange brackets) const {
2528 assert((!numElements || numElements->isTypeDependent() ||
2529 numElements->isValueDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002530 "Size must be type- or value-dependent!");
2531
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002532 // Dependently-sized array types that do not have a specified number
2533 // of elements will have their sizes deduced from a dependent
2534 // initializer. We do no canonicalization here at all, which is okay
2535 // because they can't be used in most locations.
2536 if (!numElements) {
2537 DependentSizedArrayType *newType
2538 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2539 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, QualType(),
2540 numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2541 brackets);
2542 Types.push_back(newType);
2543 return QualType(newType, 0);
2544 }
2545
2546 // Otherwise, we actually build a new type every time, but we
2547 // also build a canonical type.
2548
2549 SplitQualType canonElementType = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
2550
2551 void *insertPos = 0;
Douglas Gregor789b1f62010-02-04 18:10:26 +00002552 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002553 DependentSizedArrayType::Profile(ID, *this,
John McCall200fa532012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002554 QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002555 ASM, elementTypeQuals, numElements);
Douglas Gregorcb78d882009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002556
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002557 // Look for an existing type with these properties.
2558 DependentSizedArrayType *canonTy =
2559 DependentSizedArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
Douglas Gregorcb78d882009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002560
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002561 // If we don't have one, build one.
2562 if (!canonTy) {
2563 canonTy = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall200fa532012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002564 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002565 QualType(), numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2566 brackets);
2567 DependentSizedArrayTypes.InsertNode(canonTy, insertPos);
2568 Types.push_back(canonTy);
Douglas Gregorcb78d882009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002569 }
2570
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002571 // Apply qualifiers from the element type to the array.
2572 QualType canon = getQualifiedType(QualType(canonTy,0),
John McCall200fa532012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002573 canonElementType.Quals);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002574
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002575 // If we didn't need extra canonicalization for the element type,
2576 // then just use that as our result.
John McCall200fa532012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002577 if (QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0) == elementType)
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002578 return canon;
2579
2580 // Otherwise, we need to build a type which follows the spelling
2581 // of the element type.
2582 DependentSizedArrayType *sugaredType
2583 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2584 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, canon, numElements,
2585 ASM, elementTypeQuals, brackets);
2586 Types.push_back(sugaredType);
2587 return QualType(sugaredType, 0);
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002588}
2589
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002590QualType ASTContext::getIncompleteArrayType(QualType elementType,
Eli Friedmanc5773c42008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002591 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002592 unsigned elementTypeQuals) const {
Eli Friedmanc5773c42008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002593 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002594 IncompleteArrayType::Profile(ID, elementType, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanc5773c42008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002595
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002596 void *insertPos = 0;
2597 if (IncompleteArrayType *iat =
2598 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos))
2599 return QualType(iat, 0);
Eli Friedmanc5773c42008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002600
2601 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002602 // either, so fill in the canonical type field. We also have to pull
2603 // qualifiers off the element type.
2604 QualType canon;
Eli Friedmanc5773c42008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002605
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002606 if (!elementType.isCanonical() || elementType.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2607 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
John McCall200fa532012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002608 canon = getIncompleteArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0),
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002609 ASM, elementTypeQuals);
John McCall200fa532012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002610 canon = getQualifiedType(canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Eli Friedmanc5773c42008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002611
2612 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002613 IncompleteArrayType *existing =
2614 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2615 assert(!existing && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void) existing;
Ted Kremenek2bd24ba2007-10-29 23:37:31 +00002616 }
Eli Friedmanc5773c42008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002617
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002618 IncompleteArrayType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2619 IncompleteArrayType(elementType, canon, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanc5773c42008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002620
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002621 IncompleteArrayTypes.InsertNode(newType, insertPos);
2622 Types.push_back(newType);
2623 return QualType(newType, 0);
Steve Narofffb22d962007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002624}
2625
Steve Naroff73322922007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002626/// getVectorType - Return the unique reference to a vector type of
2627/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
John Thompson82287d12010-02-05 00:12:22 +00002628QualType ASTContext::getVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts,
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002629 VectorType::VectorKind VecKind) const {
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002630 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002631
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002632 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2633 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Bob Wilsone86d78c2010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002634 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::Vector, VecKind);
Chris Lattner788b0fd2010-06-23 06:00:24 +00002635
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002636 void *InsertPos = 0;
2637 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2638 return QualType(VTP, 0);
2639
2640 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2641 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2642 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00002643 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Bob Wilson231da7e2010-11-16 00:32:20 +00002644 Canonical = getVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts, VecKind);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002645
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002646 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2647 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinc6ed7292010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002648 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002649 }
John McCall6b304a02009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002650 VectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
Bob Wilsone86d78c2010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002651 VectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical, VecKind);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002652 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2653 Types.push_back(New);
2654 return QualType(New, 0);
2655}
2656
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002657/// getExtVectorType - Return the unique reference to an extended vector type of
Steve Naroff73322922007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002658/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002659QualType
2660ASTContext::getExtVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts) const {
Douglas Gregor4ac01402011-06-15 16:02:29 +00002661 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType() || vecType->isDependentType());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002662
Steve Naroff73322922007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002663 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2664 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner788b0fd2010-06-23 06:00:24 +00002665 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::ExtVector,
Bob Wilsone86d78c2010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002666 VectorType::GenericVector);
Steve Naroff73322922007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002667 void *InsertPos = 0;
2668 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2669 return QualType(VTP, 0);
2670
2671 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2672 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2673 QualType Canonical;
John McCall467b27b2009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002674 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002675 Canonical = getExtVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002676
Steve Naroff73322922007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002677 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2678 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinc6ed7292010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002679 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff73322922007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002680 }
John McCall6b304a02009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002681 ExtVectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2682 ExtVectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical);
Steve Naroff73322922007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002683 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2684 Types.push_back(New);
2685 return QualType(New, 0);
2686}
2687
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002688QualType
2689ASTContext::getDependentSizedExtVectorType(QualType vecType,
2690 Expr *SizeExpr,
2691 SourceLocation AttrLoc) const {
Douglas Gregor2ec09f12009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002692 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002693 DependentSizedExtVectorType::Profile(ID, *this, getCanonicalType(vecType),
Douglas Gregor2ec09f12009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002694 SizeExpr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002695
Douglas Gregor2ec09f12009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002696 void *InsertPos = 0;
2697 DependentSizedExtVectorType *Canon
2698 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2699 DependentSizedExtVectorType *New;
2700 if (Canon) {
2701 // We already have a canonical version of this array type; use it as
2702 // the canonical type for a newly-built type.
John McCall6b304a02009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002703 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2704 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(Canon, 0),
2705 SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor2ec09f12009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002706 } else {
2707 QualType CanonVecTy = getCanonicalType(vecType);
2708 if (CanonVecTy == vecType) {
John McCall6b304a02009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002709 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2710 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(), SizeExpr,
2711 AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor789b1f62010-02-04 18:10:26 +00002712
2713 DependentSizedExtVectorType *CanonCheck
2714 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2715 assert(!CanonCheck && "Dependent-sized ext_vector canonical type broken");
2716 (void)CanonCheck;
Douglas Gregor2ec09f12009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002717 DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2718 } else {
2719 QualType Canon = getDependentSizedExtVectorType(CanonVecTy, SizeExpr,
2720 SourceLocation());
John McCall6b304a02009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002721 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2722 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, Canon, SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor2ec09f12009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002723 }
2724 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002725
Douglas Gregor9cdda0c2009-06-17 21:51:59 +00002726 Types.push_back(New);
2727 return QualType(New, 0);
2728}
2729
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002730/// getFunctionNoProtoType - Return a K&R style C function type like 'int()'.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002731///
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002732QualType
2733ASTContext::getFunctionNoProtoType(QualType ResultTy,
2734 const FunctionType::ExtInfo &Info) const {
Roman Divackycfe9af22011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002735 const CallingConv DefaultCC = Info.getCC();
2736 const CallingConv CallConv = (LangOpts.MRTD && DefaultCC == CC_Default) ?
2737 CC_X86StdCall : DefaultCC;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002738 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
2739 // structure.
2740 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Rafael Espindola264ba482010-03-30 20:24:48 +00002741 FunctionNoProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, Info);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002742
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002743 void *InsertPos = 0;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002744 if (FunctionNoProtoType *FT =
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002745 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002746 return QualType(FT, 0);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002747
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002748 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregorab8bbf42010-01-18 17:14:39 +00002749 if (!ResultTy.isCanonical() ||
John McCall04a67a62010-02-05 21:31:56 +00002750 getCanonicalCallConv(CallConv) != CallConv) {
Rafael Espindola264ba482010-03-30 20:24:48 +00002751 Canonical =
2752 getFunctionNoProtoType(getCanonicalType(ResultTy),
2753 Info.withCallingConv(getCanonicalCallConv(CallConv)));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002754
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002755 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002756 FunctionNoProtoType *NewIP =
2757 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinc6ed7292010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002758 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002759 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002760
Roman Divackycfe9af22011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002761 FunctionProtoType::ExtInfo newInfo = Info.withCallingConv(CallConv);
John McCall6b304a02009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002762 FunctionNoProtoType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
Roman Divackycfe9af22011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002763 FunctionNoProtoType(ResultTy, Canonical, newInfo);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002764 Types.push_back(New);
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002765 FunctionNoProtoTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002766 return QualType(New, 0);
2767}
2768
Douglas Gregor02dd7982013-01-17 23:36:45 +00002769/// \brief Determine whether \p T is canonical as the result type of a function.
2770static bool isCanonicalResultType(QualType T) {
2771 return T.isCanonical() &&
2772 (T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None ||
2773 T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone);
2774}
2775
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002776/// getFunctionType - Return a normal function type with a typed argument
2777/// list. isVariadic indicates whether the argument list includes '...'.
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002778QualType
Jordan Rosebea522f2013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002779ASTContext::getFunctionType(QualType ResultTy, ArrayRef<QualType> ArgArray,
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002780 const FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo &EPI) const {
Jordan Rosebea522f2013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002781 size_t NumArgs = ArgArray.size();
2782
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002783 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
2784 // structure.
2785 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Jordan Rosebea522f2013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002786 FunctionProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, ArgArray.begin(), NumArgs, EPI,
2787 *this);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002788
2789 void *InsertPos = 0;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002790 if (FunctionProtoType *FTP =
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002791 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002792 return QualType(FTP, 0);
Sebastian Redl465226e2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002793
2794 // Determine whether the type being created is already canonical or not.
Richard Smitheefb3d52012-02-10 09:58:53 +00002795 bool isCanonical =
Douglas Gregor02dd7982013-01-17 23:36:45 +00002796 EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_None && isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy) &&
Richard Smitheefb3d52012-02-10 09:58:53 +00002797 !EPI.HasTrailingReturn;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002798 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs && isCanonical; ++i)
John McCall54e14c42009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002799 if (!ArgArray[i].isCanonicalAsParam())
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002800 isCanonical = false;
2801
Roman Divackycfe9af22011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002802 const CallingConv DefaultCC = EPI.ExtInfo.getCC();
2803 const CallingConv CallConv = (LangOpts.MRTD && DefaultCC == CC_Default) ?
2804 CC_X86StdCall : DefaultCC;
John McCalle23cf432010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002805
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002806 // If this type isn't canonical, get the canonical version of it.
Sebastian Redl465226e2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002807 // The exception spec is not part of the canonical type.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002808 QualType Canonical;
John McCall04a67a62010-02-05 21:31:56 +00002809 if (!isCanonical || getCanonicalCallConv(CallConv) != CallConv) {
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00002810 SmallVector<QualType, 16> CanonicalArgs;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002811 CanonicalArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
2812 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
John McCall54e14c42009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002813 CanonicalArgs.push_back(getCanonicalParamType(ArgArray[i]));
Sebastian Redl465226e2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002814
John McCalle23cf432010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002815 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo CanonicalEPI = EPI;
Richard Smitheefb3d52012-02-10 09:58:53 +00002816 CanonicalEPI.HasTrailingReturn = false;
Sebastian Redl8b5b4092011-03-06 10:52:04 +00002817 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpecType = EST_None;
2818 CanonicalEPI.NumExceptions = 0;
John McCalle23cf432010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002819 CanonicalEPI.ExtInfo
2820 = CanonicalEPI.ExtInfo.withCallingConv(getCanonicalCallConv(CallConv));
2821
Douglas Gregor02dd7982013-01-17 23:36:45 +00002822 // Result types do not have ARC lifetime qualifiers.
2823 QualType CanResultTy = getCanonicalType(ResultTy);
2824 if (ResultTy.getQualifiers().hasObjCLifetime()) {
2825 Qualifiers Qs = CanResultTy.getQualifiers();
2826 Qs.removeObjCLifetime();
2827 CanResultTy = getQualifiedType(CanResultTy.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
2828 }
2829
Jordan Rosebea522f2013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002830 Canonical = getFunctionType(CanResultTy, CanonicalArgs, CanonicalEPI);
Sebastian Redl465226e2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002831
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002832 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002833 FunctionProtoType *NewIP =
2834 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinc6ed7292010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002835 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002836 }
Sebastian Redl465226e2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002837
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002838 // FunctionProtoType objects are allocated with extra bytes after
2839 // them for three variable size arrays at the end:
2840 // - parameter types
2841 // - exception types
2842 // - consumed-arguments flags
2843 // Instead of the exception types, there could be a noexcept
Richard Smithb9d0b762012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002844 // expression, or information used to resolve the exception
2845 // specification.
John McCalle23cf432010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002846 size_t Size = sizeof(FunctionProtoType) +
Sebastian Redl60618fa2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00002847 NumArgs * sizeof(QualType);
Richard Smithb9d0b762012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002848 if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_Dynamic) {
Sebastian Redl60618fa2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00002849 Size += EPI.NumExceptions * sizeof(QualType);
Richard Smithb9d0b762012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002850 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_ComputedNoexcept) {
Sebastian Redl8026f6d2011-03-13 17:09:40 +00002851 Size += sizeof(Expr*);
Richard Smithe6975e92012-04-17 00:58:00 +00002852 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_Uninstantiated) {
Richard Smith13bffc52012-04-19 00:08:28 +00002853 Size += 2 * sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Richard Smithb9d0b762012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002854 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_Unevaluated) {
2855 Size += sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Sebastian Redl60618fa2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00002856 }
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002857 if (EPI.ConsumedArguments)
2858 Size += NumArgs * sizeof(bool);
2859
John McCalle23cf432010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002860 FunctionProtoType *FTP = (FunctionProtoType*) Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
Roman Divackycfe9af22011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002861 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo newEPI = EPI;
2862 newEPI.ExtInfo = EPI.ExtInfo.withCallingConv(CallConv);
Jordan Rosebea522f2013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002863 new (FTP) FunctionProtoType(ResultTy, ArgArray, Canonical, newEPI);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002864 Types.push_back(FTP);
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002865 FunctionProtoTypes.InsertNode(FTP, InsertPos);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002866 return QualType(FTP, 0);
2867}
2868
John McCall3cb0ebd2010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002869#ifndef NDEBUG
2870static bool NeedsInjectedClassNameType(const RecordDecl *D) {
2871 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) return false;
2872 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D);
2873 if (isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(RD))
2874 return true;
2875 if (RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() &&
2876 !isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD))
2877 return true;
2878 return false;
2879}
2880#endif
2881
2882/// getInjectedClassNameType - Return the unique reference to the
2883/// injected class name type for the specified templated declaration.
2884QualType ASTContext::getInjectedClassNameType(CXXRecordDecl *Decl,
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002885 QualType TST) const {
John McCall3cb0ebd2010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002886 assert(NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Decl));
2887 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) {
2888 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
Douglas Gregoref96ee02012-01-14 16:38:05 +00002889 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl()) {
John McCall3cb0ebd2010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002890 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous declaration has no type");
2891 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
2892 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
2893 } else {
John McCallf4c73712011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002894 Type *newType =
John McCall31f17ec2010-04-27 00:57:59 +00002895 new (*this, TypeAlignment) InjectedClassNameType(Decl, TST);
John McCallf4c73712011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002896 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2897 Types.push_back(newType);
John McCall3cb0ebd2010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002898 }
2899 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
2900}
2901
Douglas Gregor2ce52f32008-04-13 21:07:44 +00002902/// getTypeDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
2903/// specified type declaration.
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002904QualType ASTContext::getTypeDeclTypeSlow(const TypeDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1e6759e2008-10-16 16:50:47 +00002905 assert(Decl && "Passed null for Decl param");
John McCallbecb8d52010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002906 assert(!Decl->TypeForDecl && "TypeForDecl present in slow case");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002907
Richard Smith162e1c12011-04-15 14:24:37 +00002908 if (const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Decl))
Douglas Gregor2ce52f32008-04-13 21:07:44 +00002909 return getTypedefType(Typedef);
John McCallbecb8d52010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002910
John McCallbecb8d52010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002911 assert(!isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Decl) &&
2912 "Template type parameter types are always available.");
2913
John McCall19c85762010-02-16 03:57:14 +00002914 if (const RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Decl)) {
Douglas Gregoref96ee02012-01-14 16:38:05 +00002915 assert(!Record->getPreviousDecl() &&
John McCallbecb8d52010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002916 "struct/union has previous declaration");
2917 assert(!NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Record));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis400f5122010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002918 return getRecordType(Record);
John McCall19c85762010-02-16 03:57:14 +00002919 } else if (const EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Decl)) {
Douglas Gregoref96ee02012-01-14 16:38:05 +00002920 assert(!Enum->getPreviousDecl() &&
John McCallbecb8d52010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002921 "enum has previous declaration");
Argyrios Kyrtzidis400f5122010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002922 return getEnumType(Enum);
John McCall19c85762010-02-16 03:57:14 +00002923 } else if (const UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *Using =
John McCalled976492009-12-04 22:46:56 +00002924 dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Decl)) {
John McCallf4c73712011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002925 Type *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnresolvedUsingType(Using);
2926 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2927 Types.push_back(newType);
Mike Stump9fdbab32009-07-31 02:02:20 +00002928 } else
John McCallbecb8d52010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002929 llvm_unreachable("TypeDecl without a type?");
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49aa7ff2008-08-07 20:55:28 +00002930
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49aa7ff2008-08-07 20:55:28 +00002931 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Douglas Gregor2ce52f32008-04-13 21:07:44 +00002932}
2933
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002934/// getTypedefType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
Richard Smith162e1c12011-04-15 14:24:37 +00002935/// specified typedef name decl.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9763e222010-07-02 11:55:11 +00002936QualType
Richard Smith162e1c12011-04-15 14:24:37 +00002937ASTContext::getTypedefType(const TypedefNameDecl *Decl,
2938 QualType Canonical) const {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002939 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002940
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9763e222010-07-02 11:55:11 +00002941 if (Canonical.isNull())
2942 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decl->getUnderlyingType());
John McCallf4c73712011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002943 TypedefType *newType = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall6b304a02009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002944 TypedefType(Type::Typedef, Decl, Canonical);
John McCallf4c73712011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002945 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2946 Types.push_back(newType);
2947 return QualType(newType, 0);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002948}
2949
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002950QualType ASTContext::getRecordType(const RecordDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis400f5122010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002951 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
2952
Douglas Gregoref96ee02012-01-14 16:38:05 +00002953 if (const RecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis400f5122010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002954 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
2955 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
2956
John McCallf4c73712011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002957 RecordType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RecordType(Decl);
2958 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2959 Types.push_back(newType);
2960 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis400f5122010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002961}
2962
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002963QualType ASTContext::getEnumType(const EnumDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis400f5122010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002964 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
2965
Douglas Gregoref96ee02012-01-14 16:38:05 +00002966 if (const EnumDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis400f5122010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002967 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
2968 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
2969
John McCallf4c73712011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002970 EnumType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) EnumType(Decl);
2971 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2972 Types.push_back(newType);
2973 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis400f5122010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002974}
2975
John McCall9d156a72011-01-06 01:58:22 +00002976QualType ASTContext::getAttributedType(AttributedType::Kind attrKind,
2977 QualType modifiedType,
2978 QualType equivalentType) {
2979 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID id;
2980 AttributedType::Profile(id, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
2981
2982 void *insertPos = 0;
2983 AttributedType *type = AttributedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(id, insertPos);
2984 if (type) return QualType(type, 0);
2985
2986 QualType canon = getCanonicalType(equivalentType);
2987 type = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2988 AttributedType(canon, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
2989
2990 Types.push_back(type);
2991 AttributedTypes.InsertNode(type, insertPos);
2992
2993 return QualType(type, 0);
2994}
2995
2996
John McCall49a832b2009-10-18 09:09:24 +00002997/// \brief Retrieve a substitution-result type.
2998QualType
2999ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmType(const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003000 QualType Replacement) const {
John McCall467b27b2009-10-22 20:10:53 +00003001 assert(Replacement.isCanonical()
John McCall49a832b2009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003002 && "replacement types must always be canonical");
3003
3004 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3005 SubstTemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Parm, Replacement);
3006 void *InsertPos = 0;
3007 SubstTemplateTypeParmType *SubstParm
3008 = SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3009
3010 if (!SubstParm) {
3011 SubstParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3012 SubstTemplateTypeParmType(Parm, Replacement);
3013 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3014 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3015 }
3016
3017 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3018}
3019
Douglas Gregorc3069d62011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003020/// \brief Retrieve a
3021QualType ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(
3022 const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
3023 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) {
3024#ifndef NDEBUG
3025 for (TemplateArgument::pack_iterator P = ArgPack.pack_begin(),
3026 PEnd = ArgPack.pack_end();
3027 P != PEnd; ++P) {
3028 assert(P->getKind() == TemplateArgument::Type &&"Pack contains a non-type");
3029 assert(P->getAsType().isCanonical() && "Pack contains non-canonical type");
3030 }
3031#endif
3032
3033 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3034 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType::Profile(ID, Parm, ArgPack);
3035 void *InsertPos = 0;
3036 if (SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3037 = SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3038 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3039
3040 QualType Canon;
3041 if (!Parm->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
3042 Canon = getCanonicalType(QualType(Parm, 0));
3043 Canon = getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(cast<TemplateTypeParmType>(Canon),
3044 ArgPack);
3045 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3046 }
3047
3048 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3049 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(Parm, Canon,
3050 ArgPack);
3051 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3052 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3053 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3054}
3055
Douglas Gregorfab9d672009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003056/// \brief Retrieve the template type parameter type for a template
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003057/// parameter or parameter pack with the given depth, index, and (optionally)
Anders Carlsson76e4ce42009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003058/// name.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003059QualType ASTContext::getTemplateTypeParmType(unsigned Depth, unsigned Index,
Anders Carlsson76e4ce42009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003060 bool ParameterPack,
Chandler Carruth4fb86f82011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003061 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTPDecl) const {
Douglas Gregorfab9d672009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003062 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chandler Carruth4fb86f82011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003063 TemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Depth, Index, ParameterPack, TTPDecl);
Douglas Gregorfab9d672009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003064 void *InsertPos = 0;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003065 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeParm
Douglas Gregorfab9d672009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003066 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3067
3068 if (TypeParm)
3069 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003070
Chandler Carruth4fb86f82011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003071 if (TTPDecl) {
Anders Carlsson76e4ce42009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003072 QualType Canon = getTemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Chandler Carruth4fb86f82011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003073 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TemplateTypeParmType(TTPDecl, Canon);
Douglas Gregor789b1f62010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003074
3075 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeCheck
3076 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3077 assert(!TypeCheck && "Template type parameter canonical type broken");
3078 (void)TypeCheck;
Anders Carlsson76e4ce42009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003079 } else
John McCall6b304a02009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003080 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3081 TemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Douglas Gregorfab9d672009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003082
3083 Types.push_back(TypeParm);
3084 TemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(TypeParm, InsertPos);
3085
3086 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
3087}
3088
John McCall3cb0ebd2010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003089TypeSourceInfo *
3090ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationTypeInfo(TemplateName Name,
3091 SourceLocation NameLoc,
3092 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3e4c6c42011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003093 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregor7c3179c2011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003094 assert(!Name.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3095 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3e4c6c42011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003096 QualType TST = getTemplateSpecializationType(Name, Args, Underlying);
John McCall3cb0ebd2010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003097
3098 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(TST);
David Blaikie39e6ab42013-02-18 22:06:02 +00003099 TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL =
3100 DI->getTypeLoc().castAs<TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc>();
Abramo Bagnara55d23c92012-02-06 14:41:24 +00003101 TL.setTemplateKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
John McCall3cb0ebd2010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003102 TL.setTemplateNameLoc(NameLoc);
3103 TL.setLAngleLoc(Args.getLAngleLoc());
3104 TL.setRAngleLoc(Args.getRAngleLoc());
3105 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TL.getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i)
3106 TL.setArgLocInfo(i, Args[i].getLocInfo());
3107 return DI;
3108}
3109
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003110QualType
Douglas Gregor7532dc62009-03-30 22:58:21 +00003111ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003112 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3e4c6c42011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003113 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregor7c3179c2011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003114 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3115 "No dependent template names here!");
3116
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003117 unsigned NumArgs = Args.size();
3118
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003119 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> ArgVec;
John McCall833ca992009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003120 ArgVec.reserve(NumArgs);
3121 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
3122 ArgVec.push_back(Args[i].getArgument());
3123
John McCall31f17ec2010-04-27 00:57:59 +00003124 return getTemplateSpecializationType(Template, ArgVec.data(), NumArgs,
Richard Smith3e4c6c42011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003125 Underlying);
John McCall833ca992009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003126}
3127
Douglas Gregorb70126a2012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003128#ifndef NDEBUG
3129static bool hasAnyPackExpansions(const TemplateArgument *Args,
3130 unsigned NumArgs) {
3131 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3132 if (Args[I].isPackExpansion())
3133 return true;
3134
3135 return true;
3136}
3137#endif
3138
John McCall833ca992009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003139QualType
3140ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
Douglas Gregor7532dc62009-03-30 22:58:21 +00003141 const TemplateArgument *Args,
3142 unsigned NumArgs,
Richard Smith3e4c6c42011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003143 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregor7c3179c2011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003144 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3145 "No dependent template names here!");
Douglas Gregor0f0ea2a2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003146 // Look through qualified template names.
3147 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3148 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregor7c3179c2011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003149
Douglas Gregorb70126a2012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003150 bool IsTypeAlias =
Richard Smith3e4c6c42011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003151 Template.getAsTemplateDecl() &&
3152 isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(Template.getAsTemplateDecl());
Richard Smith3e4c6c42011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003153 QualType CanonType;
3154 if (!Underlying.isNull())
3155 CanonType = getCanonicalType(Underlying);
3156 else {
Douglas Gregorb70126a2012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003157 // We can get here with an alias template when the specialization contains
3158 // a pack expansion that does not match up with a parameter pack.
3159 assert((!IsTypeAlias || hasAnyPackExpansions(Args, NumArgs)) &&
3160 "Caller must compute aliased type");
3161 IsTypeAlias = false;
Richard Smith3e4c6c42011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003162 CanonType = getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args,
3163 NumArgs);
3164 }
Douglas Gregorfc705b82009-02-26 22:19:44 +00003165
Douglas Gregor1275ae02009-07-28 23:00:59 +00003166 // Allocate the (non-canonical) template specialization type, but don't
3167 // try to unique it: these types typically have location information that
3168 // we don't unique and don't want to lose.
Richard Smith3e4c6c42011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003169 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3170 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs +
Douglas Gregorb70126a2012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003171 (IsTypeAlias? sizeof(QualType) : 0),
John McCall6b304a02009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003172 TypeAlignment);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003173 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
Douglas Gregorb70126a2012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003174 = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args, NumArgs, CanonType,
3175 IsTypeAlias ? Underlying : QualType());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003176
Douglas Gregor55f6b142009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003177 Types.push_back(Spec);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003178 return QualType(Spec, 0);
Douglas Gregor55f6b142009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003179}
3180
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003181QualType
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9763e222010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003182ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
3183 const TemplateArgument *Args,
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003184 unsigned NumArgs) const {
Douglas Gregor7c3179c2011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003185 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3186 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3e4c6c42011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003187
Douglas Gregor0f0ea2a2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003188 // Look through qualified template names.
3189 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3190 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregor7c3179c2011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003191
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9763e222010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003192 // Build the canonical template specialization type.
3193 TemplateName CanonTemplate = getCanonicalTemplateName(Template);
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003194 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> CanonArgs;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9763e222010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003195 CanonArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
3196 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3197 CanonArgs.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]));
3198
3199 // Determine whether this canonical template specialization type already
3200 // exists.
3201 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3202 TemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, CanonTemplate,
3203 CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs, *this);
3204
3205 void *InsertPos = 0;
3206 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
3207 = TemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3208
3209 if (!Spec) {
3210 // Allocate a new canonical template specialization type.
3211 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3212 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3213 TypeAlignment);
3214 Spec = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(CanonTemplate,
3215 CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs,
Richard Smith3e4c6c42011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003216 QualType(), QualType());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9763e222010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003217 Types.push_back(Spec);
3218 TemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(Spec, InsertPos);
3219 }
3220
3221 assert(Spec->isDependentType() &&
3222 "Non-dependent template-id type must have a canonical type");
3223 return QualType(Spec, 0);
3224}
3225
3226QualType
Abramo Bagnara465d41b2010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003227ASTContext::getElaboratedType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3228 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003229 QualType NamedType) const {
Douglas Gregore4e5b052009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003230 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara465d41b2010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003231 ElaboratedType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, NamedType);
Douglas Gregore4e5b052009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003232
3233 void *InsertPos = 0;
Abramo Bagnara465d41b2010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003234 ElaboratedType *T = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregore4e5b052009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003235 if (T)
3236 return QualType(T, 0);
3237
Douglas Gregor789b1f62010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003238 QualType Canon = NamedType;
3239 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3240 Canon = getCanonicalType(NamedType);
Abramo Bagnara465d41b2010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003241 ElaboratedType *CheckT = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3242 assert(!CheckT && "Elaborated canonical type broken");
Douglas Gregor789b1f62010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003243 (void)CheckT;
3244 }
3245
Abramo Bagnara465d41b2010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003246 T = new (*this) ElaboratedType(Keyword, NNS, NamedType, Canon);
Douglas Gregore4e5b052009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003247 Types.push_back(T);
Abramo Bagnara465d41b2010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003248 ElaboratedTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregore4e5b052009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003249 return QualType(T, 0);
3250}
3251
Abramo Bagnara075f8f12010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003252QualType
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003253ASTContext::getParenType(QualType InnerType) const {
Abramo Bagnara075f8f12010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003254 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3255 ParenType::Profile(ID, InnerType);
3256
3257 void *InsertPos = 0;
3258 ParenType *T = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3259 if (T)
3260 return QualType(T, 0);
3261
3262 QualType Canon = InnerType;
3263 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3264 Canon = getCanonicalType(InnerType);
3265 ParenType *CheckT = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3266 assert(!CheckT && "Paren canonical type broken");
3267 (void)CheckT;
3268 }
3269
3270 T = new (*this) ParenType(InnerType, Canon);
3271 Types.push_back(T);
3272 ParenTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3273 return QualType(T, 0);
3274}
3275
Douglas Gregor4a2023f2010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003276QualType ASTContext::getDependentNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3277 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3278 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003279 QualType Canon) const {
Douglas Gregord57959a2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003280 assert(NNS->isDependent() && "nested-name-specifier must be dependent");
3281
3282 if (Canon.isNull()) {
3283 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregor4a2023f2010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003284 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3285 if (Keyword == ETK_None)
3286 CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3287
3288 if (CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword)
3289 Canon = getDependentNameType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS, Name);
Douglas Gregord57959a2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003290 }
3291
3292 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor4a2023f2010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003293 DependentNameType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregord57959a2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003294
3295 void *InsertPos = 0;
Douglas Gregor4714c122010-03-31 17:34:00 +00003296 DependentNameType *T
3297 = DependentNameTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregord57959a2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003298 if (T)
3299 return QualType(T, 0);
3300
Douglas Gregor4a2023f2010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003301 T = new (*this) DependentNameType(Keyword, NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregord57959a2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003302 Types.push_back(T);
Douglas Gregor4714c122010-03-31 17:34:00 +00003303 DependentNameTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003304 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregord57959a2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003305}
3306
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003307QualType
John McCall33500952010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003308ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3309 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
Douglas Gregor4a2023f2010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003310 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
John McCall33500952010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003311 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003312 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args) const {
John McCall33500952010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003313 // TODO: avoid this copy
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003314 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> ArgCopy;
John McCall33500952010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003315 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Args.size(); I != E; ++I)
3316 ArgCopy.push_back(Args[I].getArgument());
3317 return getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS, Name,
3318 ArgCopy.size(),
3319 ArgCopy.data());
3320}
3321
3322QualType
3323ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3324 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3325 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3326 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
3327 unsigned NumArgs,
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003328 const TemplateArgument *Args) const {
Douglas Gregoraa2187d2011-02-28 00:04:36 +00003329 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
3330 "nested-name-specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregor17343172009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003331
Douglas Gregor789b1f62010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003332 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33500952010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003333 DependentTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, *this, Keyword, NNS,
3334 Name, NumArgs, Args);
Douglas Gregor789b1f62010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003335
3336 void *InsertPos = 0;
John McCall33500952010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003337 DependentTemplateSpecializationType *T
3338 = DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor789b1f62010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003339 if (T)
3340 return QualType(T, 0);
3341
John McCall33500952010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003342 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregor789b1f62010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003343
John McCall33500952010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003344 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3345 if (Keyword == ETK_None) CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3346
3347 bool AnyNonCanonArgs = false;
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003348 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> CanonArgs(NumArgs);
John McCall33500952010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003349 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I) {
3350 CanonArgs[I] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]);
3351 if (!CanonArgs[I].structurallyEquals(Args[I]))
3352 AnyNonCanonArgs = true;
Douglas Gregor17343172009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003353 }
3354
John McCall33500952010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003355 QualType Canon;
3356 if (AnyNonCanonArgs || CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword) {
3357 Canon = getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS,
3358 Name, NumArgs,
3359 CanonArgs.data());
3360
3361 // Find the insert position again.
3362 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3363 }
3364
3365 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(DependentTemplateSpecializationType) +
3366 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3367 TypeAlignment);
John McCallef990012010-06-11 11:07:21 +00003368 T = new (Mem) DependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS,
John McCall33500952010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003369 Name, NumArgs, Args, Canon);
Douglas Gregor17343172009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003370 Types.push_back(T);
John McCall33500952010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003371 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003372 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregor17343172009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003373}
3374
Douglas Gregorcded4f62011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003375QualType ASTContext::getPackExpansionType(QualType Pattern,
David Blaikiedc84cd52013-02-20 22:23:23 +00003376 Optional<unsigned> NumExpansions) {
Douglas Gregor7536dd52010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003377 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregorcded4f62011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003378 PackExpansionType::Profile(ID, Pattern, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregor7536dd52010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003379
3380 assert(Pattern->containsUnexpandedParameterPack() &&
3381 "Pack expansions must expand one or more parameter packs");
3382 void *InsertPos = 0;
3383 PackExpansionType *T
3384 = PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3385 if (T)
3386 return QualType(T, 0);
3387
3388 QualType Canon;
3389 if (!Pattern.isCanonical()) {
Richard Smithd8672ef2012-07-16 00:20:35 +00003390 Canon = getCanonicalType(Pattern);
3391 // The canonical type might not contain an unexpanded parameter pack, if it
3392 // contains an alias template specialization which ignores one of its
3393 // parameters.
3394 if (Canon->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) {
3395 Canon = getPackExpansionType(getCanonicalType(Pattern), NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregor7536dd52010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003396
Richard Smithd8672ef2012-07-16 00:20:35 +00003397 // Find the insert position again, in case we inserted an element into
3398 // PackExpansionTypes and invalidated our insert position.
3399 PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3400 }
Douglas Gregor7536dd52010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003401 }
3402
Douglas Gregorcded4f62011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003403 T = new (*this) PackExpansionType(Pattern, Canon, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregor7536dd52010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003404 Types.push_back(T);
3405 PackExpansionTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3406 return QualType(T, 0);
3407}
3408
Chris Lattner88cb27a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003409/// CmpProtocolNames - Comparison predicate for sorting protocols
3410/// alphabetically.
3411static bool CmpProtocolNames(const ObjCProtocolDecl *LHS,
3412 const ObjCProtocolDecl *RHS) {
Douglas Gregor2e1cd422008-11-17 14:58:09 +00003413 return LHS->getDeclName() < RHS->getDeclName();
Chris Lattner88cb27a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003414}
3415
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003416static bool areSortedAndUniqued(ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
John McCall54e14c42009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003417 unsigned NumProtocols) {
3418 if (NumProtocols == 0) return true;
3419
Douglas Gregor61cc2962012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003420 if (Protocols[0]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[0])
3421 return false;
3422
John McCall54e14c42009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003423 for (unsigned i = 1; i != NumProtocols; ++i)
Douglas Gregor61cc2962012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003424 if (!CmpProtocolNames(Protocols[i-1], Protocols[i]) ||
3425 Protocols[i]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[i])
John McCall54e14c42009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003426 return false;
3427 return true;
3428}
3429
3430static void SortAndUniqueProtocols(ObjCProtocolDecl **Protocols,
Chris Lattner88cb27a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003431 unsigned &NumProtocols) {
3432 ObjCProtocolDecl **ProtocolsEnd = Protocols+NumProtocols;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003433
Chris Lattner88cb27a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003434 // Sort protocols, keyed by name.
3435 std::sort(Protocols, Protocols+NumProtocols, CmpProtocolNames);
3436
Douglas Gregor61cc2962012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003437 // Canonicalize.
3438 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NumProtocols; I != N; ++I)
3439 Protocols[I] = Protocols[I]->getCanonicalDecl();
3440
Chris Lattner88cb27a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003441 // Remove duplicates.
3442 ProtocolsEnd = std::unique(Protocols, ProtocolsEnd);
3443 NumProtocols = ProtocolsEnd-Protocols;
3444}
3445
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003446QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(QualType BaseType,
3447 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003448 unsigned NumProtocols) const {
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003449 // If the base type is an interface and there aren't any protocols
3450 // to add, then the interface type will do just fine.
3451 if (!NumProtocols && isa<ObjCInterfaceType>(BaseType))
3452 return BaseType;
3453
3454 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003455 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003456 ObjCObjectTypeImpl::Profile(ID, BaseType, Protocols, NumProtocols);
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003457 void *InsertPos = 0;
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003458 if (ObjCObjectType *QT = ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3459 return QualType(QT, 0);
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003460
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003461 // Build the canonical type, which has the canonical base type and
3462 // a sorted-and-uniqued list of protocols.
John McCall54e14c42009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003463 QualType Canonical;
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003464 bool ProtocolsSorted = areSortedAndUniqued(Protocols, NumProtocols);
3465 if (!ProtocolsSorted || !BaseType.isCanonical()) {
3466 if (!ProtocolsSorted) {
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003467 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> Sorted(Protocols,
Benjamin Kramer02379412010-04-27 17:12:11 +00003468 Protocols + NumProtocols);
John McCall54e14c42009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003469 unsigned UniqueCount = NumProtocols;
3470
John McCall54e14c42009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003471 SortAndUniqueProtocols(&Sorted[0], UniqueCount);
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003472 Canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(BaseType),
3473 &Sorted[0], UniqueCount);
John McCall54e14c42009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003474 } else {
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003475 Canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(BaseType),
3476 Protocols, NumProtocols);
John McCall54e14c42009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003477 }
3478
3479 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003480 ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3481 }
3482
3483 unsigned Size = sizeof(ObjCObjectTypeImpl);
3484 Size += NumProtocols * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *);
3485 void *Mem = Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
3486 ObjCObjectTypeImpl *T =
3487 new (Mem) ObjCObjectTypeImpl(Canonical, BaseType, Protocols, NumProtocols);
3488
3489 Types.push_back(T);
3490 ObjCObjectTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3491 return QualType(T, 0);
3492}
3493
3494/// getObjCObjectPointerType - Return a ObjCObjectPointerType type for
3495/// the given object type.
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003496QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType ObjectT) const {
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003497 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3498 ObjCObjectPointerType::Profile(ID, ObjectT);
3499
3500 void *InsertPos = 0;
3501 if (ObjCObjectPointerType *QT =
3502 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3503 return QualType(QT, 0);
3504
3505 // Find the canonical object type.
3506 QualType Canonical;
3507 if (!ObjectT.isCanonical()) {
3508 Canonical = getObjCObjectPointerType(getCanonicalType(ObjectT));
3509
3510 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCall54e14c42009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003511 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3512 }
3513
Douglas Gregorfd6a0882010-02-08 22:59:26 +00003514 // No match.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003515 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCObjectPointerType), TypeAlignment);
3516 ObjCObjectPointerType *QType =
3517 new (Mem) ObjCObjectPointerType(Canonical, ObjectT);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003518
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003519 Types.push_back(QType);
3520 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.InsertNode(QType, InsertPos);
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003521 return QualType(QType, 0);
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003522}
Chris Lattner88cb27a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003523
Douglas Gregordeacbdc2010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003524/// getObjCInterfaceType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3525/// specified ObjC interface decl. The list of protocols is optional.
Douglas Gregor0af55012011-12-16 03:12:41 +00003526QualType ASTContext::getObjCInterfaceType(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl,
3527 ObjCInterfaceDecl *PrevDecl) const {
Douglas Gregordeacbdc2010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003528 if (Decl->TypeForDecl)
3529 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003530
Douglas Gregor0af55012011-12-16 03:12:41 +00003531 if (PrevDecl) {
3532 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous decl has no TypeForDecl");
3533 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
3534 return QualType(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3535 }
3536
Douglas Gregor8d2dbbf2011-12-16 16:34:57 +00003537 // Prefer the definition, if there is one.
3538 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = Decl->getDefinition())
3539 Decl = Def;
3540
Douglas Gregordeacbdc2010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003541 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCInterfaceType), TypeAlignment);
3542 ObjCInterfaceType *T = new (Mem) ObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
3543 Decl->TypeForDecl = T;
3544 Types.push_back(T);
3545 return QualType(T, 0);
Fariborz Jahanian4b6c9052007-10-11 00:55:41 +00003546}
3547
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003548/// getTypeOfExprType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we can't unique
3549/// TypeOfExprType AST's (since expression's are never shared). For example,
Steve Naroff9752f252007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003550/// multiple declarations that refer to "typeof(x)" all contain different
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003551/// DeclRefExpr's. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates
Steve Naroff9752f252007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003552/// on canonical type's (which are always unique).
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003553QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfExprType(Expr *tofExpr) const {
Douglas Gregordd0257c2009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003554 TypeOfExprType *toe;
Douglas Gregorb1975722009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003555 if (tofExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
3556 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3557 DependentTypeOfExprType::Profile(ID, *this, tofExpr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003558
Douglas Gregorb1975722009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003559 void *InsertPos = 0;
3560 DependentTypeOfExprType *Canon
3561 = DependentTypeOfExprTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3562 if (Canon) {
3563 // We already have a "canonical" version of an identical, dependent
3564 // typeof(expr) type. Use that as our canonical type.
John McCall6b304a02009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003565 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr,
Douglas Gregorb1975722009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003566 QualType((TypeOfExprType*)Canon, 0));
Chad Rosier30601782011-08-17 23:08:45 +00003567 } else {
Douglas Gregorb1975722009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003568 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall6b304a02009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003569 Canon
3570 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentTypeOfExprType(*this, tofExpr);
Douglas Gregorb1975722009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003571 DependentTypeOfExprTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
3572 toe = Canon;
3573 }
3574 } else {
Douglas Gregordd0257c2009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003575 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofExpr->getType());
John McCall6b304a02009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003576 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr, Canonical);
Douglas Gregordd0257c2009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003577 }
Steve Naroff9752f252007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003578 Types.push_back(toe);
3579 return QualType(toe, 0);
Steve Naroffd1861fd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00003580}
3581
Steve Naroff9752f252007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003582/// getTypeOfType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique
3583/// TypeOfType AST's. The only motivation to unique these nodes would be
3584/// memory savings. Since typeof(t) is fairly uncommon, space shouldn't be
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003585/// an issue. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates
Steve Naroff9752f252007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003586/// on canonical type's (which are always unique).
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003587QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfType(QualType tofType) const {
Chris Lattnerf52ab252008-04-06 22:59:24 +00003588 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofType);
John McCall6b304a02009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003589 TypeOfType *tot = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfType(tofType, Canonical);
Steve Naroff9752f252007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003590 Types.push_back(tot);
3591 return QualType(tot, 0);
Steve Naroffd1861fd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00003592}
3593
Anders Carlsson60a9a2a2009-06-24 21:24:56 +00003594
Anders Carlsson395b4752009-06-24 19:06:50 +00003595/// getDecltypeType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique
3596/// DecltypeType AST's. The only motivation to unique these nodes would be
3597/// memory savings. Since decltype(t) is fairly uncommon, space shouldn't be
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003598/// an issue. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates
David Blaikie39e02032011-11-06 22:28:03 +00003599/// on canonical types (which are always unique).
Douglas Gregorf8af9822012-02-12 18:42:33 +00003600QualType ASTContext::getDecltypeType(Expr *e, QualType UnderlyingType) const {
Douglas Gregordd0257c2009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003601 DecltypeType *dt;
Douglas Gregor561f8122011-07-01 01:22:09 +00003602
3603 // C++0x [temp.type]p2:
3604 // If an expression e involves a template parameter, decltype(e) denotes a
3605 // unique dependent type. Two such decltype-specifiers refer to the same
3606 // type only if their expressions are equivalent (14.5.6.1).
3607 if (e->isInstantiationDependent()) {
Douglas Gregor9d702ae2009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003608 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3609 DependentDecltypeType::Profile(ID, *this, e);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003610
Douglas Gregor9d702ae2009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003611 void *InsertPos = 0;
3612 DependentDecltypeType *Canon
3613 = DependentDecltypeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3614 if (Canon) {
3615 // We already have a "canonical" version of an equivalent, dependent
3616 // decltype type. Use that as our canonical type.
Richard Smith0d729102012-08-13 20:08:14 +00003617 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType,
Douglas Gregor9d702ae2009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003618 QualType((DecltypeType*)Canon, 0));
Chad Rosier30601782011-08-17 23:08:45 +00003619 } else {
Douglas Gregor9d702ae2009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003620 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall6b304a02009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003621 Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentDecltypeType(*this, e);
Douglas Gregor9d702ae2009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003622 DependentDecltypeTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
3623 dt = Canon;
3624 }
3625 } else {
Douglas Gregorf8af9822012-02-12 18:42:33 +00003626 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType,
3627 getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
Douglas Gregordd0257c2009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003628 }
Anders Carlsson395b4752009-06-24 19:06:50 +00003629 Types.push_back(dt);
3630 return QualType(dt, 0);
3631}
3632
Sean Huntca63c202011-05-24 22:41:36 +00003633/// getUnaryTransformationType - We don't unique these, since the memory
3634/// savings are minimal and these are rare.
3635QualType ASTContext::getUnaryTransformType(QualType BaseType,
3636 QualType UnderlyingType,
3637 UnaryTransformType::UTTKind Kind)
3638 const {
3639 UnaryTransformType *Ty =
Douglas Gregor69d97752011-05-25 17:51:54 +00003640 new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType, UnderlyingType,
3641 Kind,
3642 UnderlyingType->isDependentType() ?
Peter Collingbourne12fc4b02012-03-05 16:02:06 +00003643 QualType() : getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
Sean Huntca63c202011-05-24 22:41:36 +00003644 Types.push_back(Ty);
3645 return QualType(Ty, 0);
3646}
3647
Richard Smith60e141e2013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003648/// getAutoType - Return the uniqued reference to the 'auto' type which has been
3649/// deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced 'auto' type, or the
3650/// canonical deduced-but-dependent 'auto' type.
3651QualType ASTContext::getAutoType(QualType DeducedType, bool IsDecltypeAuto,
Faisal Valiecb58192013-08-22 01:49:11 +00003652 bool IsDependent, bool IsParameterPack) const {
3653 if (DeducedType.isNull() && !IsDecltypeAuto && !IsDependent &&
3654 !IsParameterPack)
Richard Smith60e141e2013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003655 return getAutoDeductType();
Faisal Valiecb58192013-08-22 01:49:11 +00003656 assert(!IsParameterPack || DeducedType.isNull()
3657 && "Auto parameter pack: auto ... a should always be undeduced!");
Richard Smith60e141e2013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003658 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Richard Smith483b9f32011-02-21 20:05:19 +00003659 void *InsertPos = 0;
Richard Smith60e141e2013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003660 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Faisal Valiecb58192013-08-22 01:49:11 +00003661 AutoType::Profile(ID, DeducedType, IsDecltypeAuto, IsDependent,
3662 IsParameterPack);
Richard Smith60e141e2013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003663 if (AutoType *AT = AutoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3664 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smith483b9f32011-02-21 20:05:19 +00003665
Richard Smitha2c36462013-04-26 16:15:35 +00003666 AutoType *AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(DeducedType,
Richard Smithdc7a4f52013-04-30 13:56:41 +00003667 IsDecltypeAuto,
Faisal Valiecb58192013-08-22 01:49:11 +00003668 IsDependent,
3669 IsParameterPack);
Richard Smith483b9f32011-02-21 20:05:19 +00003670 Types.push_back(AT);
3671 if (InsertPos)
3672 AutoTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
3673 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smith34b41d92011-02-20 03:19:35 +00003674}
3675
Eli Friedmanb001de72011-10-06 23:00:33 +00003676/// getAtomicType - Return the uniqued reference to the atomic type for
3677/// the given value type.
3678QualType ASTContext::getAtomicType(QualType T) const {
3679 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
3680 // structure.
3681 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3682 AtomicType::Profile(ID, T);
3683
3684 void *InsertPos = 0;
3685 if (AtomicType *AT = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3686 return QualType(AT, 0);
3687
3688 // If the atomic value type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
3689 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
3690 QualType Canonical;
3691 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
3692 Canonical = getAtomicType(getCanonicalType(T));
3693
3694 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3695 AtomicType *NewIP = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3696 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
3697 }
3698 AtomicType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AtomicType(T, Canonical);
3699 Types.push_back(New);
3700 AtomicTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3701 return QualType(New, 0);
3702}
3703
Richard Smithad762fc2011-04-14 22:09:26 +00003704/// getAutoDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto'.
3705QualType ASTContext::getAutoDeductType() const {
3706 if (AutoDeductTy.isNull())
Richard Smith60e141e2013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003707 AutoDeductTy = QualType(
3708 new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(QualType(), /*decltype(auto)*/false,
Faisal Valiecb58192013-08-22 01:49:11 +00003709 /*dependent*/false,
3710 /*IsParameterPack*/false),
Richard Smith60e141e2013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003711 0);
Richard Smithad762fc2011-04-14 22:09:26 +00003712 return AutoDeductTy;
3713}
3714
3715/// getAutoRRefDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto &&'.
3716QualType ASTContext::getAutoRRefDeductType() const {
3717 if (AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull())
3718 AutoRRefDeductTy = getRValueReferenceType(getAutoDeductType());
3719 assert(!AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull() && "can't build 'auto &&' pattern");
3720 return AutoRRefDeductTy;
3721}
3722
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003723/// getTagDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3724/// specified TagDecl (struct/union/class/enum) decl.
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003725QualType ASTContext::getTagDeclType(const TagDecl *Decl) const {
Ted Kremenekd778f882007-11-26 21:16:01 +00003726 assert (Decl);
Mike Stumpe607ed02009-08-07 18:05:12 +00003727 // FIXME: What is the design on getTagDeclType when it requires casting
3728 // away const? mutable?
3729 return getTypeDeclType(const_cast<TagDecl*>(Decl));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003730}
3731
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003732/// getSizeType - Return the unique type for "size_t" (C99 7.17), the result
3733/// of the sizeof operator (C99 6.5.3.4p4). The value is target dependent and
3734/// needs to agree with the definition in <stddef.h>.
Anders Carlssona3ccda52009-12-12 00:26:23 +00003735CanQualType ASTContext::getSizeType() const {
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00003736 return getFromTargetType(Target->getSizeType());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003737}
3738
Hans Wennborg29e97cb2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00003739/// getIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "intmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
3740CanQualType ASTContext::getIntMaxType() const {
3741 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntMaxType());
3742}
3743
3744/// getUIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "uintmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
3745CanQualType ASTContext::getUIntMaxType() const {
3746 return getFromTargetType(Target->getUIntMaxType());
3747}
3748
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64c438a2008-08-09 16:51:54 +00003749/// getSignedWCharType - Return the type of "signed wchar_t".
3750/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
3751QualType ASTContext::getSignedWCharType() const {
3752 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
3753 return WCharTy;
3754}
3755
3756/// getUnsignedWCharType - Return the type of "unsigned wchar_t".
3757/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
3758QualType ASTContext::getUnsignedWCharType() const {
3759 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
3760 return UnsignedIntTy;
3761}
3762
Enea Zaffanella9677eb82013-01-26 17:08:37 +00003763QualType ASTContext::getIntPtrType() const {
3764 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntPtrType());
3765}
3766
3767QualType ASTContext::getUIntPtrType() const {
3768 return getCorrespondingUnsignedType(getIntPtrType());
3769}
3770
Hans Wennborg29e97cb2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00003771/// getPointerDiffType - Return the unique type for "ptrdiff_t" (C99 7.17)
Chris Lattner8b9023b2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00003772/// defined in <stddef.h>. Pointer - pointer requires this (C99 6.5.6p9).
3773QualType ASTContext::getPointerDiffType() const {
Douglas Gregorbcfd1f52011-09-02 00:18:52 +00003774 return getFromTargetType(Target->getPtrDiffType(0));
Chris Lattner8b9023b2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00003775}
3776
Eli Friedman6902e412012-11-27 02:58:24 +00003777/// \brief Return the unique type for "pid_t" defined in
3778/// <sys/types.h>. We need this to compute the correct type for vfork().
3779QualType ASTContext::getProcessIDType() const {
3780 return getFromTargetType(Target->getProcessIDType());
3781}
3782
Chris Lattnere6327742008-04-02 05:18:44 +00003783//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
3784// Type Operators
3785//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
3786
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003787CanQualType ASTContext::getCanonicalParamType(QualType T) const {
John McCall54e14c42009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003788 // Push qualifiers into arrays, and then discard any remaining
3789 // qualifiers.
3790 T = getCanonicalType(T);
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003791 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
John McCall54e14c42009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003792 const Type *Ty = T.getTypePtr();
John McCall54e14c42009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003793 QualType Result;
3794 if (isa<ArrayType>(Ty)) {
3795 Result = getArrayDecayedType(QualType(Ty,0));
3796 } else if (isa<FunctionType>(Ty)) {
3797 Result = getPointerType(QualType(Ty, 0));
3798 } else {
3799 Result = QualType(Ty, 0);
3800 }
3801
3802 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(Result);
3803}
3804
John McCall62c28c82011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003805QualType ASTContext::getUnqualifiedArrayType(QualType type,
3806 Qualifiers &quals) {
3807 SplitQualType splitType = type.getSplitUnqualifiedType();
3808
3809 // FIXME: getSplitUnqualifiedType() actually walks all the way to
3810 // the unqualified desugared type and then drops it on the floor.
3811 // We then have to strip that sugar back off with
3812 // getUnqualifiedDesugaredType(), which is silly.
3813 const ArrayType *AT =
John McCall200fa532012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003814 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(splitType.Ty->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
John McCall62c28c82011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003815
3816 // If we don't have an array, just use the results in splitType.
Douglas Gregor9dadd942010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003817 if (!AT) {
John McCall200fa532012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003818 quals = splitType.Quals;
3819 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003820 }
3821
John McCall62c28c82011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003822 // Otherwise, recurse on the array's element type.
3823 QualType elementType = AT->getElementType();
3824 QualType unqualElementType = getUnqualifiedArrayType(elementType, quals);
3825
3826 // If that didn't change the element type, AT has no qualifiers, so we
3827 // can just use the results in splitType.
3828 if (elementType == unqualElementType) {
3829 assert(quals.empty()); // from the recursive call
John McCall200fa532012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003830 quals = splitType.Quals;
3831 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
John McCall62c28c82011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003832 }
3833
3834 // Otherwise, add in the qualifiers from the outermost type, then
3835 // build the type back up.
John McCall200fa532012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003836 quals.addConsistentQualifiers(splitType.Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003837
Douglas Gregor9dadd942010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003838 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall62c28c82011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003839 return getConstantArrayType(unqualElementType, CAT->getSize(),
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003840 CAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
3841 }
3842
Douglas Gregor9dadd942010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003843 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall62c28c82011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003844 return getIncompleteArrayType(unqualElementType, IAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003845 }
3846
Douglas Gregor9dadd942010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003847 if (const VariableArrayType *VAT = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall62c28c82011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003848 return getVariableArrayType(unqualElementType,
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +00003849 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor9dadd942010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003850 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
3851 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
3852 VAT->getBracketsRange());
3853 }
3854
3855 const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(AT);
John McCall62c28c82011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003856 return getDependentSizedArrayType(unqualElementType, DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003857 DSAT->getSizeModifier(), 0,
3858 SourceRange());
3859}
3860
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003861/// UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes - If T1 and T2 are pointer types that
3862/// may be similar (C++ 4.4), replaces T1 and T2 with the type that
3863/// they point to and return true. If T1 and T2 aren't pointer types
3864/// or pointer-to-member types, or if they are not similar at this
3865/// level, returns false and leaves T1 and T2 unchanged. Top-level
3866/// qualifiers on T1 and T2 are ignored. This function will typically
3867/// be called in a loop that successively "unwraps" pointer and
3868/// pointer-to-member types to compare them at each level.
3869bool ASTContext::UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(QualType &T1, QualType &T2) {
3870 const PointerType *T1PtrType = T1->getAs<PointerType>(),
3871 *T2PtrType = T2->getAs<PointerType>();
3872 if (T1PtrType && T2PtrType) {
3873 T1 = T1PtrType->getPointeeType();
3874 T2 = T2PtrType->getPointeeType();
3875 return true;
3876 }
3877
3878 const MemberPointerType *T1MPType = T1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
3879 *T2MPType = T2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3880 if (T1MPType && T2MPType &&
3881 hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(T1MPType->getClass(), 0),
3882 QualType(T2MPType->getClass(), 0))) {
3883 T1 = T1MPType->getPointeeType();
3884 T2 = T2MPType->getPointeeType();
3885 return true;
3886 }
3887
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00003888 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1) {
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003889 const ObjCObjectPointerType *T1OPType = T1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
3890 *T2OPType = T2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3891 if (T1OPType && T2OPType) {
3892 T1 = T1OPType->getPointeeType();
3893 T2 = T2OPType->getPointeeType();
3894 return true;
3895 }
3896 }
3897
3898 // FIXME: Block pointers, too?
3899
3900 return false;
3901}
3902
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003903DeclarationNameInfo
3904ASTContext::getNameForTemplate(TemplateName Name,
3905 SourceLocation NameLoc) const {
John McCall14606042011-06-30 08:33:18 +00003906 switch (Name.getKind()) {
3907 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
3908 case TemplateName::Template:
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003909 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
John McCall14606042011-06-30 08:33:18 +00003910 return DeclarationNameInfo(Name.getAsTemplateDecl()->getDeclName(),
3911 NameLoc);
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003912
John McCall14606042011-06-30 08:33:18 +00003913 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate: {
3914 OverloadedTemplateStorage *Storage = Name.getAsOverloadedTemplate();
3915 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
3916 return DeclarationNameInfo((*Storage->begin())->getDeclName(), NameLoc);
3917 }
3918
3919 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
3920 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003921 DeclarationName DName;
John McCall80ad16f2009-11-24 18:42:40 +00003922 if (DTN->isIdentifier()) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003923 DName = DeclarationNames.getIdentifier(DTN->getIdentifier());
3924 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc);
John McCall80ad16f2009-11-24 18:42:40 +00003925 } else {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003926 DName = DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(DTN->getOperator());
3927 // DNInfo work in progress: FIXME: source locations?
3928 DeclarationNameLoc DNLoc;
3929 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.BeginOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
3930 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.EndOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
3931 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc, DNLoc);
John McCall80ad16f2009-11-24 18:42:40 +00003932 }
3933 }
3934
John McCall14606042011-06-30 08:33:18 +00003935 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
3936 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
3937 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
3938 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameter()->getDeclName(),
3939 NameLoc);
3940 }
3941
3942 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
3943 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
3944 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
3945 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameterPack()->getDeclName(),
3946 NameLoc);
3947 }
3948 }
3949
3950 llvm_unreachable("bad template name kind!");
John McCall80ad16f2009-11-24 18:42:40 +00003951}
3952
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003953TemplateName ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateName(TemplateName Name) const {
John McCall14606042011-06-30 08:33:18 +00003954 switch (Name.getKind()) {
3955 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
3956 case TemplateName::Template: {
3957 TemplateDecl *Template = Name.getAsTemplateDecl();
Douglas Gregor3e1274f2010-06-16 21:09:37 +00003958 if (TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP
John McCall14606042011-06-30 08:33:18 +00003959 = dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Template))
Douglas Gregor3e1274f2010-06-16 21:09:37 +00003960 Template = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(TTP);
3961
3962 // The canonical template name is the canonical template declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis97fbaa22009-07-18 00:34:25 +00003963 return TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(Template->getCanonicalDecl()));
Douglas Gregor3e1274f2010-06-16 21:09:37 +00003964 }
Douglas Gregor25a3ef72009-05-07 06:41:52 +00003965
John McCall14606042011-06-30 08:33:18 +00003966 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate:
3967 llvm_unreachable("cannot canonicalize overloaded template");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003968
John McCall14606042011-06-30 08:33:18 +00003969 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
3970 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
3971 assert(DTN && "Non-dependent template names must refer to template decls.");
3972 return DTN->CanonicalTemplateName;
3973 }
3974
3975 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
3976 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
3977 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
3978 return getCanonicalTemplateName(subst->getReplacement());
3979 }
3980
3981 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
3982 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
3983 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
3984 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *canonParameter
3985 = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(subst->getParameterPack());
3986 TemplateArgument canonArgPack
3987 = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(subst->getArgumentPack());
3988 return getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(canonParameter, canonArgPack);
3989 }
3990 }
3991
3992 llvm_unreachable("bad template name!");
Douglas Gregor25a3ef72009-05-07 06:41:52 +00003993}
3994
Douglas Gregordb0d4b72009-11-11 23:06:43 +00003995bool ASTContext::hasSameTemplateName(TemplateName X, TemplateName Y) {
3996 X = getCanonicalTemplateName(X);
3997 Y = getCanonicalTemplateName(Y);
3998 return X.getAsVoidPointer() == Y.getAsVoidPointer();
3999}
4000
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004001TemplateArgument
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004002ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) const {
Douglas Gregor1275ae02009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004003 switch (Arg.getKind()) {
4004 case TemplateArgument::Null:
4005 return Arg;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004006
Douglas Gregor1275ae02009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004007 case TemplateArgument::Expression:
Douglas Gregor1275ae02009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004008 return Arg;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004009
Douglas Gregord2008e22012-04-06 22:40:38 +00004010 case TemplateArgument::Declaration: {
Eli Friedmand7a6b162012-09-26 02:36:12 +00004011 ValueDecl *D = cast<ValueDecl>(Arg.getAsDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
4012 return TemplateArgument(D, Arg.isDeclForReferenceParam());
Douglas Gregord2008e22012-04-06 22:40:38 +00004013 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004014
Eli Friedmand7a6b162012-09-26 02:36:12 +00004015 case TemplateArgument::NullPtr:
4016 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getNullPtrType()),
4017 /*isNullPtr*/true);
4018
Douglas Gregor788cd062009-11-11 01:00:40 +00004019 case TemplateArgument::Template:
4020 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(Arg.getAsTemplate()));
Douglas Gregora7fc9012011-01-05 18:58:31 +00004021
4022 case TemplateArgument::TemplateExpansion:
4023 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(
4024 Arg.getAsTemplateOrTemplatePattern()),
Douglas Gregor2be29f42011-01-14 23:41:42 +00004025 Arg.getNumTemplateExpansions());
Douglas Gregora7fc9012011-01-05 18:58:31 +00004026
Douglas Gregor1275ae02009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004027 case TemplateArgument::Integral:
Benjamin Kramer85524372012-06-07 15:09:51 +00004028 return TemplateArgument(Arg, getCanonicalType(Arg.getIntegralType()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004029
Douglas Gregor1275ae02009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004030 case TemplateArgument::Type:
John McCall833ca992009-10-29 08:12:44 +00004031 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getAsType()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004032
Douglas Gregor1275ae02009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004033 case TemplateArgument::Pack: {
Douglas Gregor87dd6972010-12-20 16:52:59 +00004034 if (Arg.pack_size() == 0)
4035 return Arg;
4036
Douglas Gregor910f8002010-11-07 23:05:16 +00004037 TemplateArgument *CanonArgs
4038 = new (*this) TemplateArgument[Arg.pack_size()];
Douglas Gregor1275ae02009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004039 unsigned Idx = 0;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004040 for (TemplateArgument::pack_iterator A = Arg.pack_begin(),
Douglas Gregor1275ae02009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004041 AEnd = Arg.pack_end();
4042 A != AEnd; (void)++A, ++Idx)
4043 CanonArgs[Idx] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(*A);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004044
Douglas Gregor910f8002010-11-07 23:05:16 +00004045 return TemplateArgument(CanonArgs, Arg.pack_size());
Douglas Gregor1275ae02009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004046 }
4047 }
4048
4049 // Silence GCC warning
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004050 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled template argument kind");
Douglas Gregor1275ae02009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004051}
4052
Douglas Gregord57959a2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004053NestedNameSpecifier *
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004054ASTContext::getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS) const {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004055 if (!NNS)
Douglas Gregord57959a2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004056 return 0;
4057
4058 switch (NNS->getKind()) {
4059 case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier:
4060 // Canonicalize the prefix but keep the identifier the same.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004061 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this,
Douglas Gregord57959a2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004062 getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS->getPrefix()),
4063 NNS->getAsIdentifier());
4064
4065 case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace:
4066 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4067 // this namespace and no prefix.
Douglas Gregor14aba762011-02-24 02:36:08 +00004068 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, 0,
4069 NNS->getAsNamespace()->getOriginalNamespace());
4070
4071 case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias:
4072 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4073 // this namespace and no prefix.
4074 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, 0,
4075 NNS->getAsNamespaceAlias()->getNamespace()
4076 ->getOriginalNamespace());
Douglas Gregord57959a2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004077
4078 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec:
4079 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate: {
4080 QualType T = getCanonicalType(QualType(NNS->getAsType(), 0));
Douglas Gregor264bf662010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004081
4082 // If we have some kind of dependent-named type (e.g., "typename T::type"),
4083 // break it apart into its prefix and identifier, then reconsititute those
4084 // as the canonical nested-name-specifier. This is required to canonicalize
4085 // a dependent nested-name-specifier involving typedefs of dependent-name
4086 // types, e.g.,
4087 // typedef typename T::type T1;
4088 // typedef typename T1::type T2;
Eli Friedman16412ef2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00004089 if (const DependentNameType *DNT = T->getAs<DependentNameType>())
4090 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, DNT->getQualifier(),
Douglas Gregor264bf662010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004091 const_cast<IdentifierInfo *>(DNT->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregor264bf662010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004092
Eli Friedman16412ef2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00004093 // Otherwise, just canonicalize the type, and force it to be a TypeSpec.
4094 // FIXME: Why are TypeSpec and TypeSpecWithTemplate distinct in the
4095 // first place?
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004096 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, 0, false,
4097 const_cast<Type*>(T.getTypePtr()));
Douglas Gregord57959a2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004098 }
4099
4100 case NestedNameSpecifier::Global:
4101 // The global specifier is canonical and unique.
4102 return NNS;
4103 }
4104
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00004105 llvm_unreachable("Invalid NestedNameSpecifier::Kind!");
Douglas Gregord57959a2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004106}
4107
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004108
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004109const ArrayType *ASTContext::getAsArrayType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004110 // Handle the non-qualified case efficiently.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004111 if (!T.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004112 // Handle the common positive case fast.
4113 if (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(T))
4114 return AT;
4115 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004116
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004117 // Handle the common negative case fast.
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004118 if (!isa<ArrayType>(T.getCanonicalType()))
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004119 return 0;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004120
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004121 // Apply any qualifiers from the array type to the element type. This
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004122 // implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of an array type includes
4123 // any type qualifiers, the element type is so qualified, not the array type."
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004124
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004125 // If we get here, we either have type qualifiers on the type, or we have
4126 // sugar such as a typedef in the way. If we have type qualifiers on the type
Douglas Gregor50d62d12009-08-05 05:36:45 +00004127 // we must propagate them down into the element type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004128
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004129 SplitQualType split = T.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall200fa532012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004130 Qualifiers qs = split.Quals;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004131
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004132 // If we have a simple case, just return now.
John McCall200fa532012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004133 const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(split.Ty);
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004134 if (ATy == 0 || qs.empty())
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004135 return ATy;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004136
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004137 // Otherwise, we have an array and we have qualifiers on it. Push the
4138 // qualifiers into the array element type and return a new array type.
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004139 QualType NewEltTy = getQualifiedType(ATy->getElementType(), qs);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004140
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004141 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(ATy))
4142 return cast<ArrayType>(getConstantArrayType(NewEltTy, CAT->getSize(),
4143 CAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004144 CAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004145 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ATy))
4146 return cast<ArrayType>(getIncompleteArrayType(NewEltTy,
4147 IAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004148 IAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004149
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004150 if (const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004151 = dyn_cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ATy))
4152 return cast<ArrayType>(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004153 getDependentSizedArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004154 DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004155 DSAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004156 DSAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor7e7eb3d2009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004157 DSAT->getBracketsRange()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004158
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004159 const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(ATy);
Douglas Gregor7e7eb3d2009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004160 return cast<ArrayType>(getVariableArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004161 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004162 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004163 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor7e7eb3d2009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004164 VAT->getBracketsRange()));
Chris Lattner77c96472008-04-06 22:41:35 +00004165}
4166
Abramo Bagnaraad9689f2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00004167QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedParameterType(QualType T) const {
Reid Kleckner12df2462013-06-24 17:51:48 +00004168 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
4169 return getDecayedType(T);
4170 return T;
Douglas Gregor79e6bd32011-07-12 04:42:08 +00004171}
4172
Abramo Bagnaraad9689f2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00004173QualType ASTContext::getSignatureParameterType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor79e6bd32011-07-12 04:42:08 +00004174 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
4175 T = getAdjustedParameterType(T);
4176 return T.getUnqualifiedType();
4177}
4178
Chris Lattnere6327742008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004179/// getArrayDecayedType - Return the properly qualified result of decaying the
4180/// specified array type to a pointer. This operation is non-trivial when
4181/// handling typedefs etc. The canonical type of "T" must be an array type,
4182/// this returns a pointer to a properly qualified element of the array.
4183///
4184/// See C99 6.7.5.3p7 and C99 6.3.2.1p3.
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004185QualType ASTContext::getArrayDecayedType(QualType Ty) const {
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004186 // Get the element type with 'getAsArrayType' so that we don't lose any
4187 // typedefs in the element type of the array. This also handles propagation
4188 // of type qualifiers from the array type into the element type if present
4189 // (C99 6.7.3p8).
4190 const ArrayType *PrettyArrayType = getAsArrayType(Ty);
4191 assert(PrettyArrayType && "Not an array type!");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004192
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004193 QualType PtrTy = getPointerType(PrettyArrayType->getElementType());
Chris Lattnere6327742008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004194
4195 // int x[restrict 4] -> int *restrict
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004196 return getQualifiedType(PtrTy, PrettyArrayType->getIndexTypeQualifiers());
Chris Lattnere6327742008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004197}
4198
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004199QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(const ArrayType *array) const {
4200 return getBaseElementType(array->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor5e03f9e2009-07-23 23:49:00 +00004201}
4202
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004203QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(QualType type) const {
4204 Qualifiers qs;
4205 while (true) {
4206 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall200fa532012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004207 const ArrayType *array = split.Ty->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe();
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004208 if (!array) break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004209
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004210 type = array->getElementType();
John McCall200fa532012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004211 qs.addConsistentQualifiers(split.Quals);
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004212 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004213
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004214 return getQualifiedType(type, qs);
Anders Carlsson6183a992008-12-21 03:44:36 +00004215}
4216
Fariborz Jahanian0de78992009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004217/// getConstantArrayElementCount - Returns number of constant array elements.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004218uint64_t
Fariborz Jahanian0de78992009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004219ASTContext::getConstantArrayElementCount(const ConstantArrayType *CA) const {
4220 uint64_t ElementCount = 1;
4221 do {
4222 ElementCount *= CA->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Smithd5e83942012-12-06 03:04:50 +00004223 CA = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantArrayType>(
4224 CA->getElementType()->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe());
Fariborz Jahanian0de78992009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004225 } while (CA);
4226 return ElementCount;
4227}
4228
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004229/// getFloatingRank - Return a relative rank for floating point types.
4230/// This routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't a float.
Chris Lattnera75cea32008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004231static FloatingRank getFloatingRank(QualType T) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004232 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004233 return getFloatingRank(CT->getElementType());
Chris Lattnera75cea32008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004234
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004235 assert(T->getAs<BuiltinType>() && "getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
4236 switch (T->getAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004237 default: llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
Anton Korobeynikovaa4a99b2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00004238 case BuiltinType::Half: return HalfRank;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004239 case BuiltinType::Float: return FloatRank;
4240 case BuiltinType::Double: return DoubleRank;
4241 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return LongDoubleRank;
4242 }
4243}
4244
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004245/// getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain - Returns a real floating
4246/// point or a complex type (based on typeDomain/typeSize).
Steve Naroff716c7302007-08-27 01:41:48 +00004247/// 'typeDomain' is a real floating point or complex type.
4248/// 'typeSize' is a real floating point or complex type.
Chris Lattner1361b112008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004249QualType ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain(QualType Size,
4250 QualType Domain) const {
4251 FloatingRank EltRank = getFloatingRank(Size);
4252 if (Domain->isComplexType()) {
4253 switch (EltRank) {
David Blaikie561d3ab2012-01-17 02:30:50 +00004254 case HalfRank: llvm_unreachable("Complex half is not supported");
Steve Narofff1448a02007-08-27 01:27:54 +00004255 case FloatRank: return FloatComplexTy;
4256 case DoubleRank: return DoubleComplexTy;
4257 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleComplexTy;
4258 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004259 }
Chris Lattner1361b112008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004260
4261 assert(Domain->isRealFloatingType() && "Unknown domain!");
4262 switch (EltRank) {
Joey Gouly19dbb202013-01-23 11:56:20 +00004263 case HalfRank: return HalfTy;
Chris Lattner1361b112008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004264 case FloatRank: return FloatTy;
4265 case DoubleRank: return DoubleTy;
4266 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleTy;
Steve Narofff1448a02007-08-27 01:27:54 +00004267 }
David Blaikie561d3ab2012-01-17 02:30:50 +00004268 llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): illegal value for rank");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004269}
4270
Chris Lattner7cfeb082008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004271/// getFloatingTypeOrder - Compare the rank of the two specified floating
4272/// point types, ignoring the domain of the type (i.e. 'double' ==
4273/// '_Complex double'). If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004274/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004275int ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
Chris Lattnera75cea32008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004276 FloatingRank LHSR = getFloatingRank(LHS);
4277 FloatingRank RHSR = getFloatingRank(RHS);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004278
Chris Lattnera75cea32008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004279 if (LHSR == RHSR)
Steve Narofffb0d4962007-08-27 15:30:22 +00004280 return 0;
Chris Lattnera75cea32008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004281 if (LHSR > RHSR)
Steve Narofffb0d4962007-08-27 15:30:22 +00004282 return 1;
4283 return -1;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004284}
4285
Chris Lattnerf52ab252008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004286/// getIntegerRank - Return an integer conversion rank (C99 6.3.1.1p1). This
4287/// routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't an integer or enum,
4288/// or if it is not canonicalized.
John McCallf4c73712011-01-19 06:33:43 +00004289unsigned ASTContext::getIntegerRank(const Type *T) const {
John McCall467b27b2009-10-22 20:10:53 +00004290 assert(T->isCanonicalUnqualified() && "T should be canonicalized");
Alisdair Meredithf5c209d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00004291
Chris Lattnerf52ab252008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004292 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004293 default: llvm_unreachable("getIntegerRank(): not a built-in integer");
Chris Lattner7cfeb082008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004294 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Eli Friedmanf98aba32009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004295 return 1 + (getIntWidth(BoolTy) << 3);
Chris Lattner7cfeb082008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004296 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
4297 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
4298 case BuiltinType::SChar:
4299 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Eli Friedmanf98aba32009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004300 return 2 + (getIntWidth(CharTy) << 3);
Chris Lattner7cfeb082008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004301 case BuiltinType::Short:
4302 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Eli Friedmanf98aba32009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004303 return 3 + (getIntWidth(ShortTy) << 3);
Chris Lattner7cfeb082008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004304 case BuiltinType::Int:
4305 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Eli Friedmanf98aba32009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004306 return 4 + (getIntWidth(IntTy) << 3);
Chris Lattner7cfeb082008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004307 case BuiltinType::Long:
4308 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Eli Friedmanf98aba32009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004309 return 5 + (getIntWidth(LongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattner7cfeb082008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004310 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
4311 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Eli Friedmanf98aba32009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004312 return 6 + (getIntWidth(LongLongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattner2df9ced2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00004313 case BuiltinType::Int128:
4314 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
4315 return 7 + (getIntWidth(Int128Ty) << 3);
Chris Lattnerf52ab252008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004316 }
4317}
4318
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004319/// \brief Whether this is a promotable bitfield reference according
4320/// to C99 6.3.1.1p2, bullet 2 (and GCC extensions).
4321///
4322/// \returns the type this bit-field will promote to, or NULL if no
4323/// promotion occurs.
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004324QualType ASTContext::isPromotableBitField(Expr *E) const {
Douglas Gregorceafbde2010-05-24 20:13:53 +00004325 if (E->isTypeDependent() || E->isValueDependent())
4326 return QualType();
4327
John McCall993f43f2013-05-06 21:39:12 +00004328 FieldDecl *Field = E->getSourceBitField(); // FIXME: conditional bit-fields?
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004329 if (!Field)
4330 return QualType();
4331
4332 QualType FT = Field->getType();
4333
Richard Smitha6b8b2c2011-10-10 18:28:20 +00004334 uint64_t BitWidth = Field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004335 uint64_t IntSize = getTypeSize(IntTy);
4336 // GCC extension compatibility: if the bit-field size is less than or equal
4337 // to the size of int, it gets promoted no matter what its type is.
4338 // For instance, unsigned long bf : 4 gets promoted to signed int.
4339 if (BitWidth < IntSize)
4340 return IntTy;
4341
4342 if (BitWidth == IntSize)
4343 return FT->isSignedIntegerType() ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4344
4345 // Types bigger than int are not subject to promotions, and therefore act
4346 // like the base type.
4347 // FIXME: This doesn't quite match what gcc does, but what gcc does here
4348 // is ridiculous.
4349 return QualType();
4350}
4351
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004352/// getPromotedIntegerType - Returns the type that Promotable will
4353/// promote to: C99 6.3.1.1p2, assuming that Promotable is a promotable
4354/// integer type.
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004355QualType ASTContext::getPromotedIntegerType(QualType Promotable) const {
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004356 assert(!Promotable.isNull());
4357 assert(Promotable->isPromotableIntegerType());
John McCall842aef82009-12-09 09:09:27 +00004358 if (const EnumType *ET = Promotable->getAs<EnumType>())
4359 return ET->getDecl()->getPromotionType();
Eli Friedman68a2dc42011-10-26 07:22:48 +00004360
4361 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Promotable->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
4362 // C++ [conv.prom]: A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t
4363 // (3.9.1) can be converted to a prvalue of the first of the following
4364 // types that can represent all the values of its underlying type:
4365 // int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or
4366 // unsigned long long int [...]
4367 // FIXME: Is there some better way to compute this?
4368 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S ||
4369 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_U ||
4370 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char16 ||
4371 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char32) {
4372 bool FromIsSigned = BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S;
4373 uint64_t FromSize = getTypeSize(BT);
4374 QualType PromoteTypes[] = { IntTy, UnsignedIntTy, LongTy, UnsignedLongTy,
4375 LongLongTy, UnsignedLongLongTy };
4376 for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < llvm::array_lengthof(PromoteTypes); ++Idx) {
4377 uint64_t ToSize = getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
4378 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
4379 (FromSize == ToSize &&
4380 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType()))
4381 return PromoteTypes[Idx];
4382 }
4383 llvm_unreachable("char type should fit into long long");
4384 }
4385 }
4386
4387 // At this point, we should have a signed or unsigned integer type.
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004388 if (Promotable->isSignedIntegerType())
4389 return IntTy;
Eli Friedman5b64e772012-11-15 01:21:59 +00004390 uint64_t PromotableSize = getIntWidth(Promotable);
4391 uint64_t IntSize = getIntWidth(IntTy);
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004392 assert(Promotable->isUnsignedIntegerType() && PromotableSize <= IntSize);
4393 return (PromotableSize != IntSize) ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4394}
4395
Argyrios Kyrtzidis31862ba2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00004396/// \brief Recurses in pointer/array types until it finds an objc retainable
4397/// type and returns its ownership.
4398Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime ASTContext::getInnerObjCOwnership(QualType T) const {
4399 while (!T.isNull()) {
4400 if (T.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_None)
4401 return T.getObjCLifetime();
4402 if (T->isArrayType())
4403 T = getBaseElementType(T);
4404 else if (const PointerType *PT = T->getAs<PointerType>())
4405 T = PT->getPointeeType();
4406 else if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis28445f02011-07-01 23:01:46 +00004407 T = RT->getPointeeType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis31862ba2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00004408 else
4409 break;
4410 }
4411
4412 return Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4413}
4414
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004415/// getIntegerTypeOrder - Returns the highest ranked integer type:
Chris Lattner7cfeb082008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004416/// C99 6.3.1.8p1. If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004417/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004418int ASTContext::getIntegerTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
John McCallf4c73712011-01-19 06:33:43 +00004419 const Type *LHSC = getCanonicalType(LHS).getTypePtr();
4420 const Type *RHSC = getCanonicalType(RHS).getTypePtr();
Chris Lattner7cfeb082008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004421 if (LHSC == RHSC) return 0;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004422
Chris Lattnerf52ab252008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004423 bool LHSUnsigned = LHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
4424 bool RHSUnsigned = RHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004425
Chris Lattner7cfeb082008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004426 unsigned LHSRank = getIntegerRank(LHSC);
4427 unsigned RHSRank = getIntegerRank(RHSC);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004428
Chris Lattner7cfeb082008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004429 if (LHSUnsigned == RHSUnsigned) { // Both signed or both unsigned.
4430 if (LHSRank == RHSRank) return 0;
4431 return LHSRank > RHSRank ? 1 : -1;
4432 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004433
Chris Lattner7cfeb082008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004434 // Otherwise, the LHS is signed and the RHS is unsigned or visa versa.
4435 if (LHSUnsigned) {
4436 // If the unsigned [LHS] type is larger, return it.
4437 if (LHSRank >= RHSRank)
4438 return 1;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004439
Chris Lattner7cfeb082008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004440 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4441 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004442 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattner7cfeb082008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004443 return -1;
4444 }
Chris Lattnerf52ab252008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004445
Chris Lattner7cfeb082008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004446 // If the unsigned [RHS] type is larger, return it.
4447 if (RHSRank >= LHSRank)
4448 return -1;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004449
Chris Lattner7cfeb082008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004450 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4451 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004452 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattner7cfeb082008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004453 return 1;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004454}
Anders Carlsson71993dd2007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004455
Anders Carlsson79cbc7d2009-11-14 21:45:58 +00004456static RecordDecl *
Abramo Bagnaraba877ad2011-03-09 14:09:51 +00004457CreateRecordDecl(const ASTContext &Ctx, RecordDecl::TagKind TK,
4458 DeclContext *DC, IdentifierInfo *Id) {
4459 SourceLocation Loc;
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00004460 if (Ctx.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Abramo Bagnaraba877ad2011-03-09 14:09:51 +00004461 return CXXRecordDecl::Create(Ctx, TK, DC, Loc, Loc, Id);
Anders Carlsson79cbc7d2009-11-14 21:45:58 +00004462 else
Abramo Bagnaraba877ad2011-03-09 14:09:51 +00004463 return RecordDecl::Create(Ctx, TK, DC, Loc, Loc, Id);
Anders Carlsson79cbc7d2009-11-14 21:45:58 +00004464}
Abramo Bagnaraba877ad2011-03-09 14:09:51 +00004465
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004466// getCFConstantStringType - Return the type used for constant CFStrings.
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004467QualType ASTContext::getCFConstantStringType() const {
Anders Carlsson71993dd2007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004468 if (!CFConstantStringTypeDecl) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004469 CFConstantStringTypeDecl =
Abramo Bagnaraba877ad2011-03-09 14:09:51 +00004470 CreateRecordDecl(*this, TTK_Struct, TUDecl,
Anders Carlsson79cbc7d2009-11-14 21:45:58 +00004471 &Idents.get("NSConstantString"));
John McCall5cfa0112010-02-05 01:33:36 +00004472 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->startDefinition();
Anders Carlsson79cbc7d2009-11-14 21:45:58 +00004473
Anders Carlssonf06273f2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00004474 QualType FieldTypes[4];
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004475
Anders Carlsson71993dd2007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004476 // const int *isa;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004477 FieldTypes[0] = getPointerType(IntTy.withConst());
Anders Carlssonf06273f2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00004478 // int flags;
4479 FieldTypes[1] = IntTy;
Anders Carlsson71993dd2007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004480 // const char *str;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004481 FieldTypes[2] = getPointerType(CharTy.withConst());
Anders Carlsson71993dd2007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004482 // long length;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004483 FieldTypes[3] = LongTy;
4484
Anders Carlsson71993dd2007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004485 // Create fields
Douglas Gregor44b43212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00004486 for (unsigned i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004487 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*this, CFConstantStringTypeDecl,
Abramo Bagnaraff676cb2011-03-08 08:55:46 +00004488 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor44b43212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00004489 SourceLocation(), 0,
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00004490 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/0,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004491 /*BitWidth=*/0,
Richard Smith7a614d82011-06-11 17:19:42 +00004492 /*Mutable=*/false,
Richard Smithca523302012-06-10 03:12:00 +00004493 ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall2888b652010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004494 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004495 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->addDecl(Field);
Douglas Gregor44b43212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00004496 }
4497
Douglas Gregor838db382010-02-11 01:19:42 +00004498 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->completeDefinition();
Anders Carlsson71993dd2007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004499 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004500
Anders Carlsson71993dd2007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004501 return getTagDeclType(CFConstantStringTypeDecl);
Gabor Greif84675832007-09-11 15:32:40 +00004502}
Anders Carlssonb2cf3572007-10-11 01:00:40 +00004503
Fariborz Jahanianf7992132013-01-04 18:45:40 +00004504QualType ASTContext::getObjCSuperType() const {
4505 if (ObjCSuperType.isNull()) {
4506 RecordDecl *ObjCSuperTypeDecl =
4507 CreateRecordDecl(*this, TTK_Struct, TUDecl, &Idents.get("objc_super"));
4508 TUDecl->addDecl(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4509 ObjCSuperType = getTagDeclType(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4510 }
4511 return ObjCSuperType;
4512}
4513
Douglas Gregor319ac892009-04-23 22:29:11 +00004514void ASTContext::setCFConstantStringType(QualType T) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004515 const RecordType *Rec = T->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregor319ac892009-04-23 22:29:11 +00004516 assert(Rec && "Invalid CFConstantStringType");
4517 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = Rec->getDecl();
4518}
4519
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004520QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorType() const {
Mike Stumpadaaad32009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004521 if (BlockDescriptorType)
4522 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4523
4524 RecordDecl *T;
4525 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Abramo Bagnaraba877ad2011-03-09 14:09:51 +00004526 T = CreateRecordDecl(*this, TTK_Struct, TUDecl,
Anders Carlsson79cbc7d2009-11-14 21:45:58 +00004527 &Idents.get("__block_descriptor"));
John McCall5cfa0112010-02-05 01:33:36 +00004528 T->startDefinition();
Mike Stumpadaaad32009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004529
4530 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
4531 UnsignedLongTy,
4532 UnsignedLongTy,
4533 };
4534
Craig Topper3aa29df2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00004535 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpadaaad32009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004536 "reserved",
Mike Stump083c25e2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004537 "Size"
Mike Stumpadaaad32009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004538 };
4539
4540 for (size_t i = 0; i < 2; ++i) {
Abramo Bagnaraff676cb2011-03-08 08:55:46 +00004541 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*this, T, SourceLocation(),
Mike Stumpadaaad32009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004542 SourceLocation(),
4543 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00004544 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/0,
Mike Stumpadaaad32009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004545 /*BitWidth=*/0,
Richard Smith7a614d82011-06-11 17:19:42 +00004546 /*Mutable=*/false,
Richard Smithca523302012-06-10 03:12:00 +00004547 ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall2888b652010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004548 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Mike Stumpadaaad32009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004549 T->addDecl(Field);
4550 }
4551
Douglas Gregor838db382010-02-11 01:19:42 +00004552 T->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpadaaad32009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004553
4554 BlockDescriptorType = T;
4555
4556 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4557}
4558
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004559QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorExtendedType() const {
Mike Stump083c25e2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004560 if (BlockDescriptorExtendedType)
4561 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
4562
4563 RecordDecl *T;
4564 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Abramo Bagnaraba877ad2011-03-09 14:09:51 +00004565 T = CreateRecordDecl(*this, TTK_Struct, TUDecl,
Anders Carlsson79cbc7d2009-11-14 21:45:58 +00004566 &Idents.get("__block_descriptor_withcopydispose"));
John McCall5cfa0112010-02-05 01:33:36 +00004567 T->startDefinition();
Mike Stump083c25e2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004568
4569 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
4570 UnsignedLongTy,
4571 UnsignedLongTy,
4572 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy),
4573 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy)
4574 };
4575
Craig Topper3aa29df2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00004576 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stump083c25e2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004577 "reserved",
4578 "Size",
4579 "CopyFuncPtr",
4580 "DestroyFuncPtr"
4581 };
4582
4583 for (size_t i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Abramo Bagnaraff676cb2011-03-08 08:55:46 +00004584 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*this, T, SourceLocation(),
Mike Stump083c25e2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004585 SourceLocation(),
4586 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00004587 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/0,
Mike Stump083c25e2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004588 /*BitWidth=*/0,
Richard Smith7a614d82011-06-11 17:19:42 +00004589 /*Mutable=*/false,
Richard Smithca523302012-06-10 03:12:00 +00004590 ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall2888b652010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004591 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Mike Stump083c25e2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004592 T->addDecl(Field);
4593 }
4594
Douglas Gregor838db382010-02-11 01:19:42 +00004595 T->completeDefinition();
Mike Stump083c25e2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004596
4597 BlockDescriptorExtendedType = T;
4598
4599 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
4600}
4601
Fariborz Jahanianb15c8982012-11-28 23:12:17 +00004602/// BlockRequiresCopying - Returns true if byref variable "D" of type "Ty"
4603/// requires copy/dispose. Note that this must match the logic
4604/// in buildByrefHelpers.
4605bool ASTContext::BlockRequiresCopying(QualType Ty,
4606 const VarDecl *D) {
4607 if (const CXXRecordDecl *record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
4608 const Expr *copyExpr = getBlockVarCopyInits(D);
4609 if (!copyExpr && record->hasTrivialDestructor()) return false;
4610
Mike Stumpaf7b44d2009-10-21 18:16:27 +00004611 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniane38be612010-11-17 00:21:28 +00004612 }
Fariborz Jahanianb15c8982012-11-28 23:12:17 +00004613
4614 if (!Ty->isObjCRetainableType()) return false;
4615
4616 Qualifiers qs = Ty.getQualifiers();
4617
4618 // If we have lifetime, that dominates.
4619 if (Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = qs.getObjCLifetime()) {
4620 assert(getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
4621
4622 switch (lifetime) {
4623 case Qualifiers::OCL_None: llvm_unreachable("impossible");
4624
4625 // These are just bits as far as the runtime is concerned.
4626 case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone:
4627 case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing:
4628 return false;
4629
4630 // Tell the runtime that this is ARC __weak, called by the
4631 // byref routines.
4632 case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak:
4633 // ARC __strong __block variables need to be retained.
4634 case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong:
4635 return true;
4636 }
4637 llvm_unreachable("fell out of lifetime switch!");
4638 }
4639 return (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || isObjCNSObjectType(Ty) ||
4640 Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType());
Mike Stumpaf7b44d2009-10-21 18:16:27 +00004641}
4642
Fariborz Jahanian3ca23d72012-11-14 17:15:51 +00004643bool ASTContext::getByrefLifetime(QualType Ty,
4644 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime &LifeTime,
4645 bool &HasByrefExtendedLayout) const {
4646
4647 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1 ||
4648 getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC)
4649 return false;
4650
4651 HasByrefExtendedLayout = false;
Fariborz Jahanian34db84f2012-12-11 19:58:01 +00004652 if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian3ca23d72012-11-14 17:15:51 +00004653 HasByrefExtendedLayout = true;
4654 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4655 }
4656 else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount)
4657 LifeTime = Ty.getObjCLifetime();
4658 // MRR.
4659 else if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
4660 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone;
4661 else
4662 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4663 return true;
4664}
4665
Douglas Gregore97179c2011-09-08 01:46:34 +00004666TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCInstanceTypeDecl() {
4667 if (!ObjCInstanceTypeDecl)
4668 ObjCInstanceTypeDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(*this,
4669 getTranslationUnitDecl(),
4670 SourceLocation(),
4671 SourceLocation(),
4672 &Idents.get("instancetype"),
4673 getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(getObjCIdType()));
4674 return ObjCInstanceTypeDecl;
4675}
4676
Anders Carlssone8c49532007-10-29 06:33:42 +00004677// This returns true if a type has been typedefed to BOOL:
4678// typedef <type> BOOL;
Chris Lattner2d998332007-10-30 20:27:44 +00004679static bool isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(QualType T) {
Anders Carlssone8c49532007-10-29 06:33:42 +00004680 if (const TypedefType *TT = dyn_cast<TypedefType>(T))
Chris Lattnerbb49c3e2008-11-24 03:52:59 +00004681 if (IdentifierInfo *II = TT->getDecl()->getIdentifier())
4682 return II->isStr("BOOL");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004683
Anders Carlsson85f9bce2007-10-29 05:01:08 +00004684 return false;
4685}
4686
Ted Kremeneka526c5c2008-01-07 19:49:32 +00004687/// getObjCEncodingTypeSize returns size of type for objective-c encoding
Fariborz Jahanian33e1d642007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004688/// purpose.
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004689CharUnits ASTContext::getObjCEncodingTypeSize(QualType type) const {
Douglas Gregorf968d832011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004690 if (!type->isIncompleteArrayType() && type->isIncompleteType())
4691 return CharUnits::Zero();
4692
Ken Dyck199c3d62010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004693 CharUnits sz = getTypeSizeInChars(type);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004694
Fariborz Jahanian33e1d642007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004695 // Make all integer and enum types at least as large as an int
Douglas Gregor2ade35e2010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004696 if (sz.isPositive() && type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
Ken Dyck199c3d62010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004697 sz = std::max(sz, getTypeSizeInChars(IntTy));
Fariborz Jahanian33e1d642007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004698 // Treat arrays as pointers, since that's how they're passed in.
4699 else if (type->isArrayType())
Ken Dyck199c3d62010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004700 sz = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Ken Dyckaa8741a2010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004701 return sz;
Ken Dyck199c3d62010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004702}
4703
4704static inline
4705std::string charUnitsToString(const CharUnits &CU) {
4706 return llvm::itostr(CU.getQuantity());
Fariborz Jahanian33e1d642007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004707}
4708
John McCall6b5a61b2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00004709/// getObjCEncodingForBlock - Return the encoded type for this block
David Chisnall5e530af2009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004710/// declaration.
John McCall6b5a61b2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00004711std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForBlock(const BlockExpr *Expr) const {
4712 std::string S;
4713
David Chisnall5e530af2009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004714 const BlockDecl *Decl = Expr->getBlockDecl();
4715 QualType BlockTy =
4716 Expr->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4717 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian3d145f62012-11-15 19:02:45 +00004718 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Fariborz Jahanian06cffc02012-11-14 23:11:38 +00004719 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::OBJC_TQ_None,
4720 BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getResultType(),
4721 S, true /*Extended*/);
4722 else
4723 getObjCEncodingForType(BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getResultType(),
4724 S);
David Chisnall5e530af2009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004725 // Compute size of all parameters.
4726 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
4727 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
4728 SourceLocation Loc;
Ken Dyck199c3d62010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004729 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
4730 CharUnits ParmOffset = PtrSize;
Fariborz Jahanian6f46c262010-04-08 18:06:22 +00004731 for (BlockDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
David Chisnall5e530af2009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004732 E = Decl->param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
4733 QualType PType = (*PI)->getType();
Ken Dyckaa8741a2010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004734 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahanian075a5432012-06-30 00:48:59 +00004735 if (sz.isZero())
4736 continue;
Ken Dyck199c3d62010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004737 assert (sz.isPositive() && "BlockExpr - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall5e530af2009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004738 ParmOffset += sz;
4739 }
4740 // Size of the argument frame
Ken Dyck199c3d62010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004741 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
David Chisnall5e530af2009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004742 // Block pointer and offset.
4743 S += "@?0";
David Chisnall5e530af2009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004744
4745 // Argument types.
4746 ParmOffset = PtrSize;
4747 for (BlockDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(), E =
4748 Decl->param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
4749 ParmVarDecl *PVDecl = *PI;
4750 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
4751 if (const ArrayType *AT =
4752 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
4753 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
4754 // elements.
4755 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
4756 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4757 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
4758 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian3d145f62012-11-15 19:02:45 +00004759 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Fariborz Jahanian06cffc02012-11-14 23:11:38 +00004760 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, PType,
4761 S, true /*Extended*/);
4762 else
4763 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
Ken Dyck199c3d62010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004764 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckaa8741a2010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004765 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
David Chisnall5e530af2009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004766 }
John McCall6b5a61b2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00004767
4768 return S;
David Chisnall5e530af2009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004769}
4770
Douglas Gregorf968d832011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004771bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl(const FunctionDecl *Decl,
David Chisnall5389f482010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004772 std::string& S) {
4773 // Encode result type.
4774 getObjCEncodingForType(Decl->getResultType(), S);
4775 CharUnits ParmOffset;
4776 // Compute size of all parameters.
4777 for (FunctionDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
4778 E = Decl->param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
4779 QualType PType = (*PI)->getType();
4780 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregorf968d832011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004781 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian7e68ba52012-06-29 22:54:56 +00004782 continue;
4783
David Chisnall5389f482010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004784 assert (sz.isPositive() &&
Douglas Gregorf968d832011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004785 "getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall5389f482010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004786 ParmOffset += sz;
4787 }
4788 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
4789 ParmOffset = CharUnits::Zero();
4790
4791 // Argument types.
4792 for (FunctionDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
4793 E = Decl->param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
4794 ParmVarDecl *PVDecl = *PI;
4795 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
4796 if (const ArrayType *AT =
4797 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
4798 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
4799 // elements.
4800 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
4801 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4802 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
4803 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4804 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
4805 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
4806 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
4807 }
Douglas Gregorf968d832011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004808
4809 return false;
David Chisnall5389f482010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004810}
4811
Bob Wilsondc8dab62011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004812/// getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter - Return the encoded type for a single
4813/// method parameter or return type. If Extended, include class names and
4814/// block object types.
4815void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
4816 QualType T, std::string& S,
4817 bool Extended) const {
4818 // Encode type qualifer, 'in', 'inout', etc. for the parameter.
4819 getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(QT, S);
4820 // Encode parameter type.
4821 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, 0,
4822 true /*OutermostType*/,
4823 false /*EncodingProperty*/,
4824 false /*StructField*/,
4825 Extended /*EncodeBlockParameters*/,
4826 Extended /*EncodeClassNames*/);
4827}
4828
Ted Kremeneka526c5c2008-01-07 19:49:32 +00004829/// getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Return the encoded type for this method
Fariborz Jahanian33e1d642007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004830/// declaration.
Douglas Gregorf968d832011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004831bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl(const ObjCMethodDecl *Decl,
Bob Wilsondc8dab62011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004832 std::string& S,
4833 bool Extended) const {
Daniel Dunbarc56f34a2008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004834 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
Bob Wilsondc8dab62011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004835 // Encode return type.
4836 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
4837 Decl->getResultType(), S, Extended);
Fariborz Jahanian33e1d642007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004838 // Compute size of all parameters.
4839 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
4840 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
4841 SourceLocation Loc;
Ken Dyck199c3d62010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004842 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanian33e1d642007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004843 // The first two arguments (self and _cmd) are pointers; account for
4844 // their size.
Ken Dyck199c3d62010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004845 CharUnits ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis491306a2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00004846 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian7732cc92010-04-08 21:29:11 +00004847 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Chris Lattner89951a82009-02-20 18:43:26 +00004848 QualType PType = (*PI)->getType();
Ken Dyckaa8741a2010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004849 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregorf968d832011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004850 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian7e68ba52012-06-29 22:54:56 +00004851 continue;
4852
Ken Dyck199c3d62010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004853 assert (sz.isPositive() &&
4854 "getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Incomplete param type");
Fariborz Jahanian33e1d642007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004855 ParmOffset += sz;
4856 }
Ken Dyck199c3d62010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004857 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Fariborz Jahanian33e1d642007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004858 S += "@0:";
Ken Dyck199c3d62010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004859 S += charUnitsToString(PtrSize);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004860
Fariborz Jahanian33e1d642007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004861 // Argument types.
4862 ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis491306a2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00004863 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian7732cc92010-04-08 21:29:11 +00004864 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis491306a2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00004865 const ParmVarDecl *PVDecl = *PI;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004866 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
Fariborz Jahanian4306d3c2008-12-20 23:29:59 +00004867 if (const ArrayType *AT =
Steve Naroffab76d452009-04-14 00:03:58 +00004868 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
4869 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
4870 // elements.
Steve Naroffbb3fde32009-04-14 00:40:09 +00004871 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
Steve Naroffab76d452009-04-14 00:03:58 +00004872 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4873 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
4874 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Bob Wilsondc8dab62011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004875 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(PVDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
4876 PType, S, Extended);
Ken Dyck199c3d62010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004877 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckaa8741a2010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004878 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahanian33e1d642007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004879 }
Douglas Gregorf968d832011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004880
4881 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian33e1d642007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004882}
4883
Daniel Dunbarc56f34a2008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004884/// getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl - Return the encoded type for this
Fariborz Jahanian83bccb82009-01-20 20:04:12 +00004885/// property declaration. If non-NULL, Container must be either an
Daniel Dunbarc56f34a2008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004886/// ObjCCategoryImplDecl or ObjCImplementationDecl; it should only be
4887/// NULL when getting encodings for protocol properties.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004888/// Property attributes are stored as a comma-delimited C string. The simple
4889/// attributes readonly and bycopy are encoded as single characters. The
4890/// parametrized attributes, getter=name, setter=name, and ivar=name, are
4891/// encoded as single characters, followed by an identifier. Property types
4892/// are also encoded as a parametrized attribute. The characters used to encode
Fariborz Jahanian83bccb82009-01-20 20:04:12 +00004893/// these attributes are defined by the following enumeration:
4894/// @code
4895/// enum PropertyAttributes {
4896/// kPropertyReadOnly = 'R', // property is read-only.
4897/// kPropertyBycopy = 'C', // property is a copy of the value last assigned
4898/// kPropertyByref = '&', // property is a reference to the value last assigned
4899/// kPropertyDynamic = 'D', // property is dynamic
4900/// kPropertyGetter = 'G', // followed by getter selector name
4901/// kPropertySetter = 'S', // followed by setter selector name
4902/// kPropertyInstanceVariable = 'V' // followed by instance variable name
Bob Wilson0d4cb852012-03-22 17:48:02 +00004903/// kPropertyType = 'T' // followed by old-style type encoding.
Fariborz Jahanian83bccb82009-01-20 20:04:12 +00004904/// kPropertyWeak = 'W' // 'weak' property
4905/// kPropertyStrong = 'P' // property GC'able
4906/// kPropertyNonAtomic = 'N' // property non-atomic
4907/// };
4908/// @endcode
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004909void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl(const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
Daniel Dunbarc56f34a2008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004910 const Decl *Container,
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004911 std::string& S) const {
Daniel Dunbarc56f34a2008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004912 // Collect information from the property implementation decl(s).
4913 bool Dynamic = false;
4914 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *SynthesizePID = 0;
4915
4916 // FIXME: Duplicated code due to poor abstraction.
4917 if (Container) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004918 if (const ObjCCategoryImplDecl *CID =
Daniel Dunbarc56f34a2008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004919 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(Container)) {
4920 for (ObjCCategoryImplDecl::propimpl_iterator
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004921 i = CID->propimpl_begin(), e = CID->propimpl_end();
Douglas Gregor653f1b12009-04-23 01:02:12 +00004922 i != e; ++i) {
David Blaikie581deb32012-06-06 20:45:41 +00004923 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PID = *i;
Daniel Dunbarc56f34a2008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004924 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD) {
4925 if (PID->getPropertyImplementation()==ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic) {
4926 Dynamic = true;
4927 } else {
4928 SynthesizePID = PID;
4929 }
4930 }
4931 }
4932 } else {
Chris Lattner61710852008-10-05 17:34:18 +00004933 const ObjCImplementationDecl *OID=cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(Container);
Daniel Dunbarc56f34a2008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004934 for (ObjCCategoryImplDecl::propimpl_iterator
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004935 i = OID->propimpl_begin(), e = OID->propimpl_end();
Douglas Gregor653f1b12009-04-23 01:02:12 +00004936 i != e; ++i) {
David Blaikie581deb32012-06-06 20:45:41 +00004937 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PID = *i;
Daniel Dunbarc56f34a2008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004938 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD) {
4939 if (PID->getPropertyImplementation()==ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic) {
4940 Dynamic = true;
4941 } else {
4942 SynthesizePID = PID;
4943 }
4944 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004945 }
Daniel Dunbarc56f34a2008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004946 }
4947 }
4948
4949 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
4950 S = "T";
4951
4952 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian090b3f72009-01-20 19:14:18 +00004953 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
4954 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004955 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PD->getType(), S, true, true, 0,
Fariborz Jahanian090b3f72009-01-20 19:14:18 +00004956 true /* outermost type */,
4957 true /* encoding for property */);
Daniel Dunbarc56f34a2008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004958
4959 if (PD->isReadOnly()) {
4960 S += ",R";
Nico Weberd7ceab32013-05-08 23:47:40 +00004961 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_copy)
4962 S += ",C";
4963 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_retain)
4964 S += ",&";
Daniel Dunbarc56f34a2008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004965 } else {
4966 switch (PD->getSetterKind()) {
4967 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Assign: break;
4968 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Copy: S += ",C"; break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004969 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Retain: S += ",&"; break;
Fariborz Jahanian3a02b442011-08-12 20:47:08 +00004970 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Weak: S += ",W"; break;
Daniel Dunbarc56f34a2008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004971 }
4972 }
4973
4974 // It really isn't clear at all what this means, since properties
4975 // are "dynamic by default".
4976 if (Dynamic)
4977 S += ",D";
4978
Fariborz Jahanian090b3f72009-01-20 19:14:18 +00004979 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_nonatomic)
4980 S += ",N";
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004981
Daniel Dunbarc56f34a2008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004982 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_getter) {
4983 S += ",G";
Chris Lattner077bf5e2008-11-24 03:33:13 +00004984 S += PD->getGetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbarc56f34a2008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004985 }
4986
4987 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_setter) {
4988 S += ",S";
Chris Lattner077bf5e2008-11-24 03:33:13 +00004989 S += PD->getSetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbarc56f34a2008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004990 }
4991
4992 if (SynthesizePID) {
4993 const ObjCIvarDecl *OID = SynthesizePID->getPropertyIvarDecl();
4994 S += ",V";
Chris Lattner39f34e92008-11-24 04:00:27 +00004995 S += OID->getNameAsString();
Daniel Dunbarc56f34a2008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004996 }
4997
4998 // FIXME: OBJCGC: weak & strong
4999}
5000
Fariborz Jahaniana1c033e2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005001/// getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding -
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005002/// Another legacy compatibility encoding: 32-bit longs are encoded as
5003/// 'l' or 'L' , but not always. For typedefs, we need to use
Fariborz Jahaniana1c033e2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005004/// 'i' or 'I' instead if encoding a struct field, or a pointer!
5005///
5006void ASTContext::getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding (QualType &PointeeTy) const {
Mike Stump8e1fab22009-07-22 18:58:19 +00005007 if (isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005008 if (const BuiltinType *BT = PointeeTy->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005009 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::ULong && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahaniana1c033e2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005010 PointeeTy = UnsignedIntTy;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005011 else
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005012 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Long && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahaniana1c033e2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005013 PointeeTy = IntTy;
5014 }
5015 }
5016}
5017
Fariborz Jahanian7d6b46d2008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005018void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForType(QualType T, std::string& S,
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005019 const FieldDecl *Field) const {
Daniel Dunbar82a6cfb2008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005020 // We follow the behavior of gcc, expanding structures which are
5021 // directly pointed to, and expanding embedded structures. Note that
5022 // these rules are sufficient to prevent recursive encoding of the
5023 // same type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005024 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, Field,
Fariborz Jahanian5b8c7d92008-12-22 23:22:27 +00005025 true /* outermost type */);
Daniel Dunbar82a6cfb2008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005026}
5027
John McCall3624e9e2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005028static char getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(const ASTContext *C,
5029 BuiltinType::Kind kind) {
5030 switch (kind) {
David Chisnall64fd7e82010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005031 case BuiltinType::Void: return 'v';
5032 case BuiltinType::Bool: return 'B';
5033 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
5034 case BuiltinType::UChar: return 'C';
John McCall3624e9e2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005035 case BuiltinType::Char16:
David Chisnall64fd7e82010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005036 case BuiltinType::UShort: return 'S';
John McCall3624e9e2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005037 case BuiltinType::Char32:
David Chisnall64fd7e82010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005038 case BuiltinType::UInt: return 'I';
5039 case BuiltinType::ULong:
John McCall3624e9e2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005040 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'L' : 'Q';
David Chisnall64fd7e82010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005041 case BuiltinType::UInt128: return 'T';
5042 case BuiltinType::ULongLong: return 'Q';
5043 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
5044 case BuiltinType::SChar: return 'c';
5045 case BuiltinType::Short: return 's';
Chris Lattner3f59c972010-12-25 23:25:43 +00005046 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
5047 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
David Chisnall64fd7e82010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005048 case BuiltinType::Int: return 'i';
5049 case BuiltinType::Long:
John McCall3624e9e2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005050 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'l' : 'q';
David Chisnall64fd7e82010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005051 case BuiltinType::LongLong: return 'q';
5052 case BuiltinType::Int128: return 't';
5053 case BuiltinType::Float: return 'f';
5054 case BuiltinType::Double: return 'd';
Daniel Dunbar3a0be842010-10-11 21:13:48 +00005055 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return 'D';
John McCall3624e9e2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005056 case BuiltinType::NullPtr: return '*'; // like char*
5057
5058 case BuiltinType::Half:
5059 // FIXME: potentially need @encodes for these!
5060 return ' ';
5061
5062 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
5063 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
5064 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
5065 llvm_unreachable("@encoding ObjC primitive type");
5066
5067 // OpenCL and placeholder types don't need @encodings.
5068 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d:
5069 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray:
5070 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer:
5071 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d:
5072 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray:
5073 case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d:
Guy Benyeie6b9d802013-01-20 12:31:11 +00005074 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Guy Benyei21f18c42013-02-07 10:55:47 +00005075 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
John McCall3624e9e2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005076 case BuiltinType::Dependent:
5077#define BUILTIN_TYPE(KIND, ID)
5078#define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(KIND, ID) \
5079 case BuiltinType::KIND:
5080#include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
5081 llvm_unreachable("invalid builtin type for @encode");
David Chisnall64fd7e82010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005082 }
David Blaikie719e53f2013-01-09 17:48:41 +00005083 llvm_unreachable("invalid BuiltinType::Kind value");
David Chisnall64fd7e82010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005084}
5085
Douglas Gregor5471bc82011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005086static char ObjCEncodingForEnumType(const ASTContext *C, const EnumType *ET) {
5087 EnumDecl *Enum = ET->getDecl();
5088
5089 // The encoding of an non-fixed enum type is always 'i', regardless of size.
5090 if (!Enum->isFixed())
5091 return 'i';
5092
5093 // The encoding of a fixed enum type matches its fixed underlying type.
John McCall3624e9e2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005094 const BuiltinType *BT = Enum->getIntegerType()->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5095 return getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(C, BT->getKind());
Douglas Gregor5471bc82011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005096}
5097
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005098static void EncodeBitField(const ASTContext *Ctx, std::string& S,
David Chisnall64fd7e82010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005099 QualType T, const FieldDecl *FD) {
Richard Smitha6b8b2c2011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005100 assert(FD->isBitField() && "not a bitfield - getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl");
Fariborz Jahanian8b4bf902009-01-13 01:18:13 +00005101 S += 'b';
David Chisnall64fd7e82010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005102 // The NeXT runtime encodes bit fields as b followed by the number of bits.
5103 // The GNU runtime requires more information; bitfields are encoded as b,
5104 // then the offset (in bits) of the first element, then the type of the
5105 // bitfield, then the size in bits. For example, in this structure:
5106 //
5107 // struct
5108 // {
5109 // int integer;
5110 // int flags:2;
5111 // };
5112 // On a 32-bit system, the encoding for flags would be b2 for the NeXT
5113 // runtime, but b32i2 for the GNU runtime. The reason for this extra
5114 // information is not especially sensible, but we're stuck with it for
5115 // compatibility with GCC, although providing it breaks anything that
5116 // actually uses runtime introspection and wants to work on both runtimes...
John McCall260611a2012-06-20 06:18:46 +00005117 if (Ctx->getLangOpts().ObjCRuntime.isGNUFamily()) {
David Chisnall64fd7e82010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005118 const RecordDecl *RD = FD->getParent();
5119 const ASTRecordLayout &RL = Ctx->getASTRecordLayout(RD);
Eli Friedman82905742011-07-07 01:54:01 +00005120 S += llvm::utostr(RL.getFieldOffset(FD->getFieldIndex()));
Douglas Gregor5471bc82011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005121 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
5122 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(Ctx, ET);
John McCall3624e9e2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005123 else {
5124 const BuiltinType *BT = T->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5125 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(Ctx, BT->getKind());
5126 }
David Chisnall64fd7e82010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005127 }
Richard Smitha6b8b2c2011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005128 S += llvm::utostr(FD->getBitWidthValue(*Ctx));
Fariborz Jahanian8b4bf902009-01-13 01:18:13 +00005129}
5130
Daniel Dunbar01eb9b92009-10-18 21:17:35 +00005131// FIXME: Use SmallString for accumulating string.
Daniel Dunbar82a6cfb2008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005132void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(QualType T, std::string& S,
5133 bool ExpandPointedToStructures,
5134 bool ExpandStructures,
Daniel Dunbar153bfe52009-04-20 06:37:24 +00005135 const FieldDecl *FD,
Fariborz Jahanian090b3f72009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005136 bool OutermostType,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis26361972011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005137 bool EncodingProperty,
Bob Wilsondc8dab62011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005138 bool StructField,
5139 bool EncodeBlockParameters,
Fariborz Jahanian17c1a2e2013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005140 bool EncodeClassNames,
5141 bool EncodePointerToObjCTypedef) const {
John McCall3624e9e2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005142 CanQualType CT = getCanonicalType(T);
5143 switch (CT->getTypeClass()) {
5144 case Type::Builtin:
5145 case Type::Enum:
Chris Lattnerce7b38c2009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005146 if (FD && FD->isBitField())
David Chisnall64fd7e82010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005147 return EncodeBitField(this, S, T, FD);
John McCall3624e9e2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005148 if (const BuiltinType *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CT))
5149 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(this, BT->getKind());
5150 else
5151 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(this, cast<EnumType>(CT));
Chris Lattnerce7b38c2009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005152 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005153
John McCall3624e9e2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005154 case Type::Complex: {
5155 const ComplexType *CT = T->castAs<ComplexType>();
Anders Carlssonc612f7b2009-04-09 21:55:45 +00005156 S += 'j';
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005157 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(CT->getElementType(), S, false, false, 0, false,
Anders Carlssonc612f7b2009-04-09 21:55:45 +00005158 false);
Chris Lattnerce7b38c2009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005159 return;
5160 }
John McCall3624e9e2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005161
5162 case Type::Atomic: {
5163 const AtomicType *AT = T->castAs<AtomicType>();
5164 S += 'A';
5165 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getValueType(), S, false, false, 0,
5166 false, false);
5167 return;
Fariborz Jahanianaa1d7612010-04-13 23:45:47 +00005168 }
John McCall3624e9e2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005169
5170 // encoding for pointer or reference types.
5171 case Type::Pointer:
5172 case Type::LValueReference:
5173 case Type::RValueReference: {
5174 QualType PointeeTy;
5175 if (isa<PointerType>(CT)) {
5176 const PointerType *PT = T->castAs<PointerType>();
5177 if (PT->isObjCSelType()) {
5178 S += ':';
5179 return;
5180 }
5181 PointeeTy = PT->getPointeeType();
5182 } else {
5183 PointeeTy = T->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
5184 }
5185
Fariborz Jahaniana1c033e2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005186 bool isReadOnly = false;
5187 // For historical/compatibility reasons, the read-only qualifier of the
5188 // pointee gets emitted _before_ the '^'. The read-only qualifier of
5189 // the pointer itself gets ignored, _unless_ we are looking at a typedef!
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005190 // Also, do not emit the 'r' for anything but the outermost type!
Mike Stump8e1fab22009-07-22 18:58:19 +00005191 if (isa<TypedefType>(T.getTypePtr())) {
Fariborz Jahaniana1c033e2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005192 if (OutermostType && T.isConstQualified()) {
5193 isReadOnly = true;
5194 S += 'r';
5195 }
Mike Stump9fdbab32009-07-31 02:02:20 +00005196 } else if (OutermostType) {
Fariborz Jahaniana1c033e2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005197 QualType P = PointeeTy;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005198 while (P->getAs<PointerType>())
5199 P = P->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahaniana1c033e2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005200 if (P.isConstQualified()) {
5201 isReadOnly = true;
5202 S += 'r';
5203 }
5204 }
5205 if (isReadOnly) {
5206 // Another legacy compatibility encoding. Some ObjC qualifier and type
5207 // combinations need to be rearranged.
5208 // Rewrite "in const" from "nr" to "rn"
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00005209 if (StringRef(S).endswith("nr"))
Benjamin Kramer02379412010-04-27 17:12:11 +00005210 S.replace(S.end()-2, S.end(), "rn");
Fariborz Jahaniana1c033e2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005211 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005212
Anders Carlsson85f9bce2007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005213 if (PointeeTy->isCharType()) {
5214 // char pointer types should be encoded as '*' unless it is a
5215 // type that has been typedef'd to 'BOOL'.
Anders Carlssone8c49532007-10-29 06:33:42 +00005216 if (!isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(PointeeTy)) {
Anders Carlsson85f9bce2007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005217 S += '*';
5218 return;
5219 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005220 } else if (const RecordType *RTy = PointeeTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Steve Naroff9533a7f2009-07-22 17:14:51 +00005221 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_class *" to "#".
5222 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_class")) {
5223 S += '#';
5224 return;
5225 }
5226 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_object *" to "@".
5227 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_object")) {
5228 S += '@';
5229 return;
5230 }
5231 // fall through...
Anders Carlsson85f9bce2007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005232 }
Anders Carlsson85f9bce2007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005233 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahaniana1c033e2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005234 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(PointeeTy);
5235
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005236 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S, false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Fariborz Jahanian43822ea2008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005237 NULL);
Chris Lattnerce7b38c2009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005238 return;
5239 }
John McCall3624e9e2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005240
5241 case Type::ConstantArray:
5242 case Type::IncompleteArray:
5243 case Type::VariableArray: {
5244 const ArrayType *AT = cast<ArrayType>(CT);
5245
Argyrios Kyrtzidis26361972011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005246 if (isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT) && !StructField) {
Anders Carlsson559a8332009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005247 // Incomplete arrays are encoded as a pointer to the array element.
5248 S += '^';
5249
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005250 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Anders Carlsson559a8332009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005251 false, ExpandStructures, FD);
5252 } else {
5253 S += '[';
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005254
Fariborz Jahanian48eff6c2013-06-04 16:04:37 +00005255 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5256 S += llvm::utostr(CAT->getSize().getZExtValue());
5257 else {
Anders Carlsson559a8332009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005258 //Variable length arrays are encoded as a regular array with 0 elements.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis26361972011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005259 assert((isa<VariableArrayType>(AT) || isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) &&
5260 "Unknown array type!");
Anders Carlsson559a8332009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005261 S += '0';
5262 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005263
5264 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Anders Carlsson559a8332009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005265 false, ExpandStructures, FD);
5266 S += ']';
5267 }
Chris Lattnerce7b38c2009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005268 return;
5269 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005270
John McCall3624e9e2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005271 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
5272 case Type::FunctionProto:
Anders Carlssonc0a87b72007-10-30 00:06:20 +00005273 S += '?';
Chris Lattnerce7b38c2009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005274 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005275
John McCall3624e9e2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005276 case Type::Record: {
5277 RecordDecl *RDecl = cast<RecordType>(CT)->getDecl();
Daniel Dunbard96b35b2008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005278 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? '(' : '{';
Daniel Dunbar502a4a12008-10-17 06:22:57 +00005279 // Anonymous structures print as '?'
5280 if (const IdentifierInfo *II = RDecl->getIdentifier()) {
5281 S += II->getName();
Fariborz Jahanian6fb94392010-05-07 00:28:49 +00005282 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
5283 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RDecl)) {
5284 const TemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Benjamin Kramer5eada842013-02-22 15:46:01 +00005285 llvm::raw_string_ostream OS(S);
5286 TemplateSpecializationType::PrintTemplateArgumentList(OS,
Douglas Gregor910f8002010-11-07 23:05:16 +00005287 TemplateArgs.data(),
5288 TemplateArgs.size(),
Douglas Gregor30c42402011-09-27 22:38:19 +00005289 (*this).getPrintingPolicy());
Fariborz Jahanian6fb94392010-05-07 00:28:49 +00005290 }
Daniel Dunbar502a4a12008-10-17 06:22:57 +00005291 } else {
5292 S += '?';
5293 }
Daniel Dunbar0d504c12008-10-17 20:21:44 +00005294 if (ExpandStructures) {
Fariborz Jahanian7d6b46d2008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005295 S += '=';
Argyrios Kyrtzidis26361972011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005296 if (!RDecl->isUnion()) {
5297 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RDecl, S, FD);
5298 } else {
5299 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator Field = RDecl->field_begin(),
5300 FieldEnd = RDecl->field_end();
5301 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
5302 if (FD) {
5303 S += '"';
5304 S += Field->getNameAsString();
5305 S += '"';
5306 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005307
Argyrios Kyrtzidis26361972011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005308 // Special case bit-fields.
5309 if (Field->isBitField()) {
5310 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true,
David Blaikie581deb32012-06-06 20:45:41 +00005311 *Field);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis26361972011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005312 } else {
5313 QualType qt = Field->getType();
5314 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
5315 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true,
5316 FD, /*OutermostType*/false,
5317 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
5318 /*StructField*/true);
5319 }
Daniel Dunbard96b35b2008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005320 }
Fariborz Jahanian7d6b46d2008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005321 }
Fariborz Jahanian6de88a82007-11-13 23:21:38 +00005322 }
Daniel Dunbard96b35b2008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005323 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? ')' : '}';
Chris Lattnerce7b38c2009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005324 return;
5325 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005326
John McCall3624e9e2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005327 case Type::BlockPointer: {
5328 const BlockPointerType *BT = T->castAs<BlockPointerType>();
Steve Naroff21a98b12009-02-02 18:24:29 +00005329 S += "@?"; // Unlike a pointer-to-function, which is "^?".
Bob Wilsondc8dab62011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005330 if (EncodeBlockParameters) {
John McCall3624e9e2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005331 const FunctionType *FT = BT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
Bob Wilsondc8dab62011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005332
5333 S += '<';
5334 // Block return type
5335 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(FT->getResultType(), S,
5336 ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures,
5337 FD,
5338 false /* OutermostType */,
5339 EncodingProperty,
5340 false /* StructField */,
5341 EncodeBlockParameters,
5342 EncodeClassNames);
5343 // Block self
5344 S += "@?";
5345 // Block parameters
5346 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
5347 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator I = FPT->arg_type_begin(),
5348 E = FPT->arg_type_end(); I && (I != E); ++I) {
5349 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(*I, S,
5350 ExpandPointedToStructures,
5351 ExpandStructures,
5352 FD,
5353 false /* OutermostType */,
5354 EncodingProperty,
5355 false /* StructField */,
5356 EncodeBlockParameters,
5357 EncodeClassNames);
5358 }
5359 }
5360 S += '>';
5361 }
Chris Lattnerce7b38c2009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005362 return;
5363 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005364
John McCall3624e9e2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005365 case Type::ObjCObject:
5366 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
5367 // Ignore protocol qualifiers when mangling at this level.
5368 T = T->castAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getBaseType();
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005369
John McCall3624e9e2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005370 // The assumption seems to be that this assert will succeed
5371 // because nested levels will have filtered out 'id' and 'Class'.
5372 const ObjCInterfaceType *OIT = T->castAs<ObjCInterfaceType>();
Fariborz Jahanian43822ea2008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005373 // @encode(class_name)
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005374 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OIT->getDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian43822ea2008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005375 S += '{';
5376 const IdentifierInfo *II = OI->getIdentifier();
5377 S += II->getName();
5378 S += '=';
Jordy Rosedb8264e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00005379 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
Fariborz Jahanian2c18bb72010-08-20 21:21:08 +00005380 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
5381 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Jordy Rosedb8264e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00005382 const FieldDecl *Field = cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]);
Fariborz Jahanian2c18bb72010-08-20 21:21:08 +00005383 if (Field->isBitField())
5384 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, Field);
Fariborz Jahanian43822ea2008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005385 else
Fariborz Jahanian17c1a2e2013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005386 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, FD,
5387 false, false, false, false, false,
5388 EncodePointerToObjCTypedef);
Fariborz Jahanian43822ea2008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005389 }
5390 S += '}';
Chris Lattnerce7b38c2009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005391 return;
Fariborz Jahanian43822ea2008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005392 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005393
John McCall3624e9e2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005394 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
5395 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = T->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005396 if (OPT->isObjCIdType()) {
5397 S += '@';
5398 return;
Chris Lattnerce7b38c2009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005399 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005400
Steve Naroff27d20a22009-10-28 22:03:49 +00005401 if (OPT->isObjCClassType() || OPT->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) {
5402 // FIXME: Consider if we need to output qualifiers for 'Class<p>'.
5403 // Since this is a binary compatibility issue, need to consult with runtime
5404 // folks. Fortunately, this is a *very* obsure construct.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005405 S += '#';
5406 return;
Chris Lattnerce7b38c2009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005407 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005408
Chris Lattnerce7b38c2009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005409 if (OPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005410 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(getObjCIdType(), S,
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005411 ExpandPointedToStructures,
5412 ExpandStructures, FD);
Bob Wilsondc8dab62011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005413 if (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005414 // Note that we do extended encoding of protocol qualifer list
5415 // Only when doing ivar or property encoding.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005416 S += '"';
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005417 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = OPT->qual_begin(),
5418 E = OPT->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005419 S += '<';
5420 S += (*I)->getNameAsString();
5421 S += '>';
5422 }
5423 S += '"';
5424 }
5425 return;
Chris Lattnerce7b38c2009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005426 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005427
Chris Lattnerce7b38c2009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005428 QualType PointeeTy = OPT->getPointeeType();
5429 if (!EncodingProperty &&
Fariborz Jahanian17c1a2e2013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005430 isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr()) &&
5431 !EncodePointerToObjCTypedef) {
Chris Lattnerce7b38c2009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005432 // Another historical/compatibility reason.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005433 // We encode the underlying type which comes out as
Chris Lattnerce7b38c2009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005434 // {...};
5435 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian361a3292013-07-12 16:19:11 +00005436 if (FD && OPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc1310462013-07-12 16:41:56 +00005437 // Prevent recursive encoding of fields in some rare cases.
Fariborz Jahanian361a3292013-07-12 16:19:11 +00005438 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OPT->getInterfaceDecl();
5439 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
5440 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
5441 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
5442 if (cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]) == FD) {
5443 S += '{';
5444 S += OI->getIdentifier()->getName();
5445 S += '}';
5446 return;
5447 }
5448 }
5449 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005450 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S,
5451 false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Fariborz Jahanian17c1a2e2013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005452 NULL,
5453 false, false, false, false, false,
5454 /*EncodePointerToObjCTypedef*/true);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005455 return;
5456 }
Chris Lattnerce7b38c2009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005457
5458 S += '@';
Bob Wilsondc8dab62011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005459 if (OPT->getInterfaceDecl() &&
5460 (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames)) {
Chris Lattnerce7b38c2009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005461 S += '"';
Steve Naroff27d20a22009-10-28 22:03:49 +00005462 S += OPT->getInterfaceDecl()->getIdentifier()->getName();
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005463 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = OPT->qual_begin(),
5464 E = OPT->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Chris Lattnerce7b38c2009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005465 S += '<';
5466 S += (*I)->getNameAsString();
5467 S += '>';
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005468 }
Chris Lattnerce7b38c2009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005469 S += '"';
5470 }
5471 return;
5472 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005473
John McCall532ec7b2010-05-17 23:56:34 +00005474 // gcc just blithely ignores member pointers.
John McCall3624e9e2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005475 // FIXME: we shoul do better than that. 'M' is available.
5476 case Type::MemberPointer:
John McCall532ec7b2010-05-17 23:56:34 +00005477 return;
Fariborz Jahaniane6012c72010-10-07 21:25:25 +00005478
John McCall3624e9e2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005479 case Type::Vector:
5480 case Type::ExtVector:
Fariborz Jahaniane6012c72010-10-07 21:25:25 +00005481 // This matches gcc's encoding, even though technically it is
5482 // insufficient.
5483 // FIXME. We should do a better job than gcc.
5484 return;
John McCall3624e9e2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005485
Richard Smithdc7a4f52013-04-30 13:56:41 +00005486 case Type::Auto:
5487 // We could see an undeduced auto type here during error recovery.
5488 // Just ignore it.
5489 return;
5490
John McCall3624e9e2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005491#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5492#define TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5493#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5494 case Type::KIND:
5495#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5496 case Type::KIND:
5497#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5498 case Type::KIND:
5499#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
5500 llvm_unreachable("@encode for dependent type!");
Fariborz Jahaniane6012c72010-10-07 21:25:25 +00005501 }
John McCall3624e9e2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005502 llvm_unreachable("bad type kind!");
Anders Carlsson85f9bce2007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005503}
5504
Argyrios Kyrtzidis26361972011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005505void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RecordDecl *RDecl,
5506 std::string &S,
5507 const FieldDecl *FD,
5508 bool includeVBases) const {
5509 assert(RDecl && "Expected non-null RecordDecl");
5510 assert(!RDecl->isUnion() && "Should not be called for unions");
5511 if (!RDecl->getDefinition())
5512 return;
5513
5514 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRec = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RDecl);
5515 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *> FieldOrBaseOffsets;
5516 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RDecl);
5517
5518 if (CXXRec) {
5519 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator
5520 BI = CXXRec->bases_begin(),
5521 BE = CXXRec->bases_end(); BI != BE; ++BI) {
5522 if (!BI->isVirtual()) {
5523 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis829f2002011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005524 if (base->isEmpty())
5525 continue;
Benjamin Kramerd4f51982012-07-04 18:45:14 +00005526 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getBaseClassOffset(base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis26361972011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005527 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
5528 std::make_pair(offs, base));
5529 }
5530 }
5531 }
5532
5533 unsigned i = 0;
5534 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator Field = RDecl->field_begin(),
5535 FieldEnd = RDecl->field_end();
5536 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field, ++i) {
5537 uint64_t offs = layout.getFieldOffset(i);
5538 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
David Blaikie581deb32012-06-06 20:45:41 +00005539 std::make_pair(offs, *Field));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis26361972011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005540 }
5541
5542 if (CXXRec && includeVBases) {
5543 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator
5544 BI = CXXRec->vbases_begin(),
5545 BE = CXXRec->vbases_end(); BI != BE; ++BI) {
5546 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis829f2002011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005547 if (base->isEmpty())
5548 continue;
Benjamin Kramerd4f51982012-07-04 18:45:14 +00005549 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getVBaseClassOffset(base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis19aa8602011-09-26 18:14:24 +00005550 if (FieldOrBaseOffsets.find(offs) == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end())
5551 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(),
5552 std::make_pair(offs, base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis26361972011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005553 }
5554 }
5555
5556 CharUnits size;
5557 if (CXXRec) {
5558 size = includeVBases ? layout.getSize() : layout.getNonVirtualSize();
5559 } else {
5560 size = layout.getSize();
5561 }
5562
5563 uint64_t CurOffs = 0;
5564 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *>::iterator
5565 CurLayObj = FieldOrBaseOffsets.begin();
5566
Douglas Gregor58db7a52012-04-27 22:30:01 +00005567 if (CXXRec && CXXRec->isDynamicClass() &&
5568 (CurLayObj == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end() || CurLayObj->first != 0)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis26361972011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005569 if (FD) {
5570 S += "\"_vptr$";
5571 std::string recname = CXXRec->getNameAsString();
5572 if (recname.empty()) recname = "?";
5573 S += recname;
5574 S += '"';
5575 }
5576 S += "^^?";
5577 CurOffs += getTypeSize(VoidPtrTy);
5578 }
5579
5580 if (!RDecl->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) {
5581 // Mark the end of the structure.
5582 uint64_t offs = toBits(size);
5583 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
5584 std::make_pair(offs, (NamedDecl*)0));
5585 }
5586
5587 for (; CurLayObj != FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(); ++CurLayObj) {
5588 assert(CurOffs <= CurLayObj->first);
5589
5590 if (CurOffs < CurLayObj->first) {
5591 uint64_t padding = CurLayObj->first - CurOffs;
5592 // FIXME: There doesn't seem to be a way to indicate in the encoding that
5593 // packing/alignment of members is different that normal, in which case
5594 // the encoding will be out-of-sync with the real layout.
5595 // If the runtime switches to just consider the size of types without
5596 // taking into account alignment, we could make padding explicit in the
5597 // encoding (e.g. using arrays of chars). The encoding strings would be
5598 // longer then though.
5599 CurOffs += padding;
5600 }
5601
5602 NamedDecl *dcl = CurLayObj->second;
5603 if (dcl == 0)
5604 break; // reached end of structure.
5605
5606 if (CXXRecordDecl *base = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(dcl)) {
5607 // We expand the bases without their virtual bases since those are going
5608 // in the initial structure. Note that this differs from gcc which
5609 // expands virtual bases each time one is encountered in the hierarchy,
5610 // making the encoding type bigger than it really is.
5611 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(base, S, FD, /*includeVBases*/false);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis829f2002011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005612 assert(!base->isEmpty());
5613 CurOffs += toBits(getASTRecordLayout(base).getNonVirtualSize());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis26361972011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005614 } else {
5615 FieldDecl *field = cast<FieldDecl>(dcl);
5616 if (FD) {
5617 S += '"';
5618 S += field->getNameAsString();
5619 S += '"';
5620 }
5621
5622 if (field->isBitField()) {
5623 EncodeBitField(this, S, field->getType(), field);
Richard Smitha6b8b2c2011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005624 CurOffs += field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis26361972011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005625 } else {
5626 QualType qt = field->getType();
5627 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
5628 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true, FD,
5629 /*OutermostType*/false,
5630 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
5631 /*StructField*/true);
5632 CurOffs += getTypeSize(field->getType());
5633 }
5634 }
5635 }
5636}
5637
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005638void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
Fariborz Jahanianecb01e62007-11-01 17:18:37 +00005639 std::string& S) const {
5640 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_In)
5641 S += 'n';
5642 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Inout)
5643 S += 'N';
5644 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Out)
5645 S += 'o';
5646 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Bycopy)
5647 S += 'O';
5648 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Byref)
5649 S += 'R';
5650 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Oneway)
5651 S += 'V';
5652}
5653
Douglas Gregor4dfd02a2011-08-12 05:46:01 +00005654TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCIdDecl() const {
5655 if (!ObjCIdDecl) {
5656 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, 0, 0);
5657 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
5658 TypeSourceInfo *IdInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
5659 ObjCIdDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this),
5660 getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5661 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5662 &Idents.get("id"), IdInfo);
5663 }
5664
5665 return ObjCIdDecl;
Steve Naroff7e219e42007-10-15 14:41:52 +00005666}
5667
Douglas Gregor7a27ea52011-08-12 06:17:30 +00005668TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCSelDecl() const {
5669 if (!ObjCSelDecl) {
5670 QualType SelT = getPointerType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy);
5671 TypeSourceInfo *SelInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(SelT);
5672 ObjCSelDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this),
5673 getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5674 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5675 &Idents.get("SEL"), SelInfo);
5676 }
5677 return ObjCSelDecl;
Fariborz Jahanianb62f6812007-10-16 20:40:23 +00005678}
5679
Douglas Gregor79d67262011-08-12 05:59:41 +00005680TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCClassDecl() const {
5681 if (!ObjCClassDecl) {
5682 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, 0, 0);
5683 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
5684 TypeSourceInfo *ClassInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
5685 ObjCClassDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this),
5686 getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5687 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5688 &Idents.get("Class"), ClassInfo);
5689 }
5690
5691 return ObjCClassDecl;
Anders Carlsson8baaca52007-10-31 02:53:19 +00005692}
5693
Douglas Gregora6ea10e2012-01-17 18:09:05 +00005694ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjCProtocolDecl() const {
5695 if (!ObjCProtocolClassDecl) {
5696 ObjCProtocolClassDecl
5697 = ObjCInterfaceDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5698 SourceLocation(),
5699 &Idents.get("Protocol"),
5700 /*PrevDecl=*/0,
5701 SourceLocation(), true);
5702 }
5703
5704 return ObjCProtocolClassDecl;
5705}
5706
Meador Ingec5613b22012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005707//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
5708// __builtin_va_list Construction Functions
5709//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
5710
5711static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5712 // typedef char* __builtin_va_list;
5713 QualType CharPtrType = Context->getPointerType(Context->CharTy);
5714 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo
5715 = Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(CharPtrType);
5716
5717 TypedefDecl *VaListTypeDecl
5718 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5719 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5720 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5721 &Context->Idents.get("__builtin_va_list"),
5722 TInfo);
5723 return VaListTypeDecl;
5724}
5725
5726static TypedefDecl *CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5727 // typedef void* __builtin_va_list;
5728 QualType VoidPtrType = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5729 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo
5730 = Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(VoidPtrType);
5731
5732 TypedefDecl *VaListTypeDecl
5733 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5734 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5735 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5736 &Context->Idents.get("__builtin_va_list"),
5737 TInfo);
5738 return VaListTypeDecl;
5739}
5740
Tim Northoverc264e162013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005741static TypedefDecl *
5742CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5743 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
5744 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
5745 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
5746 NamespaceDecl *NS;
5747 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5748 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5749 /*Inline*/false, SourceLocation(),
5750 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
5751 /*PrevDecl*/0);
5752
5753 VaListTagDecl = CXXRecordDecl::Create(*Context, TTK_Struct,
5754 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5755 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5756 &Context->Idents.get("__va_list"));
5757 VaListTagDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
5758 } else {
5759 // struct __va_list
5760 VaListTagDecl = CreateRecordDecl(*Context, TTK_Struct,
5761 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5762 &Context->Idents.get("__va_list"));
5763 }
5764
5765 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
5766
5767 const size_t NumFields = 5;
5768 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
5769 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
5770
5771 // void *__stack;
5772 FieldTypes[0] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5773 FieldNames[0] = "__stack";
5774
5775 // void *__gr_top;
5776 FieldTypes[1] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5777 FieldNames[1] = "__gr_top";
5778
5779 // void *__vr_top;
5780 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5781 FieldNames[2] = "__vr_top";
5782
5783 // int __gr_offs;
5784 FieldTypes[3] = Context->IntTy;
5785 FieldNames[3] = "__gr_offs";
5786
5787 // int __vr_offs;
5788 FieldTypes[4] = Context->IntTy;
5789 FieldNames[4] = "__vr_offs";
5790
5791 // Create fields
5792 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
5793 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5794 VaListTagDecl,
5795 SourceLocation(),
5796 SourceLocation(),
5797 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
5798 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/0,
5799 /*BitWidth=*/0,
5800 /*Mutable=*/false,
5801 ICIS_NoInit);
5802 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
5803 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
5804 }
5805 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
5806 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
5807 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
5808
5809 // } __builtin_va_list;
5810 TypedefDecl *VaListTypedefDecl
5811 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5812 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5813 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5814 &Context->Idents.get("__builtin_va_list"),
5815 Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(VaListTagType));
5816
5817 return VaListTypedefDecl;
5818}
5819
Meador Ingec5613b22012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005820static TypedefDecl *CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5821 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
5822 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
5823
5824 VaListTagDecl = CreateRecordDecl(*Context, TTK_Struct,
5825 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5826 &Context->Idents.get("__va_list_tag"));
5827 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
5828
5829 const size_t NumFields = 5;
5830 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
5831 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
5832
5833 // unsigned char gpr;
5834 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
5835 FieldNames[0] = "gpr";
5836
5837 // unsigned char fpr;
5838 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
5839 FieldNames[1] = "fpr";
5840
5841 // unsigned short reserved;
5842 FieldTypes[2] = Context->UnsignedShortTy;
5843 FieldNames[2] = "reserved";
5844
5845 // void* overflow_arg_area;
5846 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5847 FieldNames[3] = "overflow_arg_area";
5848
5849 // void* reg_save_area;
5850 FieldTypes[4] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5851 FieldNames[4] = "reg_save_area";
5852
5853 // Create fields
5854 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
5855 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*Context, VaListTagDecl,
5856 SourceLocation(),
5857 SourceLocation(),
5858 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
5859 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/0,
5860 /*BitWidth=*/0,
5861 /*Mutable=*/false,
5862 ICIS_NoInit);
5863 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
5864 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
5865 }
5866 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
5867 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Meador Ingefb40e3f2012-07-01 15:57:25 +00005868 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
Meador Ingec5613b22012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005869
5870 // } __va_list_tag;
5871 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl
5872 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5873 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5874 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5875 &Context->Idents.get("__va_list_tag"),
5876 Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(VaListTagType));
5877 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
5878 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
5879
5880 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
5881 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
5882 QualType VaListTagArrayType
5883 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
5884 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
5885 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo
5886 = Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(VaListTagArrayType);
5887 TypedefDecl *VaListTypedefDecl
5888 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5889 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5890 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5891 &Context->Idents.get("__builtin_va_list"),
5892 TInfo);
5893
5894 return VaListTypedefDecl;
5895}
5896
5897static TypedefDecl *
5898CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5899 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
5900 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
5901 VaListTagDecl = CreateRecordDecl(*Context, TTK_Struct,
5902 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5903 &Context->Idents.get("__va_list_tag"));
5904 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
5905
5906 const size_t NumFields = 4;
5907 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
5908 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
5909
5910 // unsigned gp_offset;
5911 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
5912 FieldNames[0] = "gp_offset";
5913
5914 // unsigned fp_offset;
5915 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
5916 FieldNames[1] = "fp_offset";
5917
5918 // void* overflow_arg_area;
5919 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5920 FieldNames[2] = "overflow_arg_area";
5921
5922 // void* reg_save_area;
5923 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5924 FieldNames[3] = "reg_save_area";
5925
5926 // Create fields
5927 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
5928 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5929 VaListTagDecl,
5930 SourceLocation(),
5931 SourceLocation(),
5932 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
5933 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/0,
5934 /*BitWidth=*/0,
5935 /*Mutable=*/false,
5936 ICIS_NoInit);
5937 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
5938 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
5939 }
5940 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
5941 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Meador Ingefb40e3f2012-07-01 15:57:25 +00005942 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
Meador Ingec5613b22012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005943
5944 // } __va_list_tag;
5945 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl
5946 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5947 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5948 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5949 &Context->Idents.get("__va_list_tag"),
5950 Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(VaListTagType));
5951 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
5952 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
5953
5954 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
5955 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
5956 QualType VaListTagArrayType
5957 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
5958 Size, ArrayType::Normal,0);
5959 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo
5960 = Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(VaListTagArrayType);
5961 TypedefDecl *VaListTypedefDecl
5962 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5963 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5964 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5965 &Context->Idents.get("__builtin_va_list"),
5966 TInfo);
5967
5968 return VaListTypedefDecl;
5969}
5970
5971static TypedefDecl *CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5972 // typedef int __builtin_va_list[4];
5973 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 4);
5974 QualType IntArrayType
5975 = Context->getConstantArrayType(Context->IntTy,
5976 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
5977 TypedefDecl *VaListTypedefDecl
5978 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5979 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5980 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5981 &Context->Idents.get("__builtin_va_list"),
5982 Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(IntArrayType));
5983
5984 return VaListTypedefDecl;
5985}
5986
Logan Chieneae5a8202012-10-10 06:56:20 +00005987static TypedefDecl *
5988CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5989 RecordDecl *VaListDecl;
5990 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
5991 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
5992 NamespaceDecl *NS;
5993 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5994 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5995 /*Inline*/false, SourceLocation(),
5996 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
5997 /*PrevDecl*/0);
5998
5999 VaListDecl = CXXRecordDecl::Create(*Context, TTK_Struct,
6000 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6001 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
6002 &Context->Idents.get("__va_list"));
6003
6004 VaListDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
6005
6006 } else {
6007 // struct __va_list {
6008 VaListDecl = CreateRecordDecl(*Context, TTK_Struct,
6009 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6010 &Context->Idents.get("__va_list"));
6011 }
6012
6013 VaListDecl->startDefinition();
6014
6015 // void * __ap;
6016 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6017 VaListDecl,
6018 SourceLocation(),
6019 SourceLocation(),
6020 &Context->Idents.get("__ap"),
6021 Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy),
6022 /*TInfo=*/0,
6023 /*BitWidth=*/0,
6024 /*Mutable=*/false,
6025 ICIS_NoInit);
6026 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6027 VaListDecl->addDecl(Field);
6028
6029 // };
6030 VaListDecl->completeDefinition();
6031
6032 // typedef struct __va_list __builtin_va_list;
6033 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo
6034 = Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(Context->getRecordType(VaListDecl));
6035
6036 TypedefDecl *VaListTypeDecl
6037 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6038 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6039 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
6040 &Context->Idents.get("__builtin_va_list"),
6041 TInfo);
6042
6043 return VaListTypeDecl;
6044}
6045
Ulrich Weigandb8409212013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006046static TypedefDecl *
6047CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6048 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
6049 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
6050 VaListTagDecl = CreateRecordDecl(*Context, TTK_Struct,
6051 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6052 &Context->Idents.get("__va_list_tag"));
6053 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6054
6055 const size_t NumFields = 4;
6056 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6057 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6058
6059 // long __gpr;
6060 FieldTypes[0] = Context->LongTy;
6061 FieldNames[0] = "__gpr";
6062
6063 // long __fpr;
6064 FieldTypes[1] = Context->LongTy;
6065 FieldNames[1] = "__fpr";
6066
6067 // void *__overflow_arg_area;
6068 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6069 FieldNames[2] = "__overflow_arg_area";
6070
6071 // void *__reg_save_area;
6072 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6073 FieldNames[3] = "__reg_save_area";
6074
6075 // Create fields
6076 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6077 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6078 VaListTagDecl,
6079 SourceLocation(),
6080 SourceLocation(),
6081 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
6082 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/0,
6083 /*BitWidth=*/0,
6084 /*Mutable=*/false,
6085 ICIS_NoInit);
6086 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6087 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6088 }
6089 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
6090 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6091 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
6092
6093 // } __va_list_tag;
6094 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl
6095 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6096 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6097 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
6098 &Context->Idents.get("__va_list_tag"),
6099 Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(VaListTagType));
6100 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
6101 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
6102
6103 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6104 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
6105 QualType VaListTagArrayType
6106 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
6107 Size, ArrayType::Normal,0);
6108 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo
6109 = Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(VaListTagArrayType);
6110 TypedefDecl *VaListTypedefDecl
6111 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6112 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6113 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
6114 &Context->Idents.get("__builtin_va_list"),
6115 TInfo);
6116
6117 return VaListTypedefDecl;
6118}
6119
Meador Ingec5613b22012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006120static TypedefDecl *CreateVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
6121 TargetInfo::BuiltinVaListKind Kind) {
6122 switch (Kind) {
6123 case TargetInfo::CharPtrBuiltinVaList:
6124 return CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6125 case TargetInfo::VoidPtrBuiltinVaList:
6126 return CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Tim Northoverc264e162013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006127 case TargetInfo::AArch64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6128 return CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Ingec5613b22012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006129 case TargetInfo::PowerABIBuiltinVaList:
6130 return CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6131 case TargetInfo::X86_64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6132 return CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6133 case TargetInfo::PNaClABIBuiltinVaList:
6134 return CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Logan Chieneae5a8202012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006135 case TargetInfo::AAPCSABIBuiltinVaList:
6136 return CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Ulrich Weigandb8409212013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006137 case TargetInfo::SystemZBuiltinVaList:
6138 return CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Ingec5613b22012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006139 }
6140
6141 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled __builtin_va_list type kind");
6142}
6143
6144TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinVaListDecl() const {
6145 if (!BuiltinVaListDecl)
6146 BuiltinVaListDecl = CreateVaListDecl(this, Target->getBuiltinVaListKind());
6147
6148 return BuiltinVaListDecl;
6149}
6150
Meador Ingefb40e3f2012-07-01 15:57:25 +00006151QualType ASTContext::getVaListTagType() const {
6152 // Force the creation of VaListTagTy by building the __builtin_va_list
6153 // declaration.
6154 if (VaListTagTy.isNull())
6155 (void) getBuiltinVaListDecl();
6156
6157 return VaListTagTy;
6158}
6159
Ted Kremeneka526c5c2008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006160void ASTContext::setObjCConstantStringInterface(ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006161 assert(ObjCConstantStringType.isNull() &&
Steve Naroff21988912007-10-15 23:35:17 +00006162 "'NSConstantString' type already set!");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006163
Ted Kremeneka526c5c2008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006164 ObjCConstantStringType = getObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
Steve Naroff21988912007-10-15 23:35:17 +00006165}
6166
John McCall0bd6feb2009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006167/// \brief Retrieve the template name that corresponds to a non-empty
6168/// lookup.
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006169TemplateName
6170ASTContext::getOverloadedTemplateName(UnresolvedSetIterator Begin,
6171 UnresolvedSetIterator End) const {
John McCall0bd6feb2009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006172 unsigned size = End - Begin;
6173 assert(size > 1 && "set is not overloaded!");
6174
6175 void *memory = Allocate(sizeof(OverloadedTemplateStorage) +
6176 size * sizeof(FunctionTemplateDecl*));
6177 OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = new(memory) OverloadedTemplateStorage(size);
6178
6179 NamedDecl **Storage = OT->getStorage();
John McCalleec51cf2010-01-20 00:46:10 +00006180 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = Begin; I != End; ++I) {
John McCall0bd6feb2009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006181 NamedDecl *D = *I;
6182 assert(isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) ||
6183 (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) &&
6184 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D->getUnderlyingDecl())));
6185 *Storage++ = D;
6186 }
6187
6188 return TemplateName(OT);
6189}
6190
Douglas Gregor7532dc62009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006191/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a qualified
6192/// template name such as \c std::vector.
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006193TemplateName
6194ASTContext::getQualifiedTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6195 bool TemplateKeyword,
6196 TemplateDecl *Template) const {
Douglas Gregor0f0ea2a2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00006197 assert(NNS && "Missing nested-name-specifier in qualified template name");
6198
Douglas Gregor789b1f62010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006199 // FIXME: Canonicalization?
Douglas Gregor7532dc62009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006200 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6201 QualifiedTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
6202
6203 void *InsertPos = 0;
6204 QualifiedTemplateName *QTN =
6205 QualifiedTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6206 if (!QTN) {
Richard Smith2f47cab2012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006207 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<QualifiedTemplateName>())
6208 QualifiedTemplateName(NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
Douglas Gregor7532dc62009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006209 QualifiedTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6210 }
6211
6212 return TemplateName(QTN);
6213}
6214
6215/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6216/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template apply.
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006217TemplateName
6218ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6219 const IdentifierInfo *Name) const {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006220 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor3b6afbb2009-09-09 00:23:06 +00006221 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregor7532dc62009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006222
6223 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6224 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Name);
6225
6226 void *InsertPos = 0;
6227 DependentTemplateName *QTN =
6228 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6229
6230 if (QTN)
6231 return TemplateName(QTN);
6232
6233 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6234 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Richard Smith2f47cab2012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006235 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6236 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor7532dc62009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006237 } else {
6238 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Name);
Richard Smith2f47cab2012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006239 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6240 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregor789b1f62010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006241 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN =
6242 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6243 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent type name canonicalization broken");
6244 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregor7532dc62009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006245 }
6246
6247 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6248 return TemplateName(QTN);
6249}
6250
Douglas Gregorca1bdd72009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006251/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6252/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template operator+.
6253TemplateName
6254ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006255 OverloadedOperatorKind Operator) const {
Douglas Gregorca1bdd72009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006256 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
6257 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
6258
6259 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6260 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Operator);
6261
6262 void *InsertPos = 0;
Douglas Gregor789b1f62010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006263 DependentTemplateName *QTN
6264 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregorca1bdd72009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006265
6266 if (QTN)
6267 return TemplateName(QTN);
6268
6269 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6270 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Richard Smith2f47cab2012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006271 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6272 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator);
Douglas Gregorca1bdd72009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006273 } else {
6274 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Operator);
Richard Smith2f47cab2012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006275 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6276 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator, Canon);
Douglas Gregor789b1f62010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006277
6278 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN
6279 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6280 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent template name canonicalization broken");
6281 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregorca1bdd72009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006282 }
6283
6284 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6285 return TemplateName(QTN);
6286}
6287
Douglas Gregor1aee05d2011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006288TemplateName
John McCall14606042011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006289ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParm(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *param,
6290 TemplateName replacement) const {
6291 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6292 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage::Profile(ID, param, replacement);
6293
6294 void *insertPos = 0;
6295 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
6296 = SubstTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
6297
6298 if (!subst) {
6299 subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage(param, replacement);
6300 SubstTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(subst, insertPos);
6301 }
6302
6303 return TemplateName(subst);
6304}
6305
6306TemplateName
Douglas Gregor1aee05d2011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006307ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Param,
6308 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) const {
6309 ASTContext &Self = const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this);
6310 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6311 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage::Profile(ID, Self, Param, ArgPack);
6312
6313 void *InsertPos = 0;
6314 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *Subst
6315 = SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6316
6317 if (!Subst) {
John McCall14606042011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006318 Subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage(Param,
Douglas Gregor1aee05d2011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006319 ArgPack.pack_size(),
6320 ArgPack.pack_begin());
6321 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.InsertNode(Subst, InsertPos);
6322 }
6323
6324 return TemplateName(Subst);
6325}
6326
Douglas Gregorb4e66d52008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006327/// getFromTargetType - Given one of the integer types provided by
Douglas Gregord9341122008-11-03 15:57:00 +00006328/// TargetInfo, produce the corresponding type. The unsigned @p Type
6329/// is actually a value of type @c TargetInfo::IntType.
John McCalle27ec8a2009-10-23 23:03:21 +00006330CanQualType ASTContext::getFromTargetType(unsigned Type) const {
Douglas Gregorb4e66d52008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006331 switch (Type) {
John McCalle27ec8a2009-10-23 23:03:21 +00006332 case TargetInfo::NoInt: return CanQualType();
Douglas Gregorb4e66d52008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006333 case TargetInfo::SignedShort: return ShortTy;
6334 case TargetInfo::UnsignedShort: return UnsignedShortTy;
6335 case TargetInfo::SignedInt: return IntTy;
6336 case TargetInfo::UnsignedInt: return UnsignedIntTy;
6337 case TargetInfo::SignedLong: return LongTy;
6338 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLong: return UnsignedLongTy;
6339 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong: return LongLongTy;
6340 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLongLong: return UnsignedLongLongTy;
6341 }
6342
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00006343 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::IntType value");
Douglas Gregorb4e66d52008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006344}
Ted Kremenekb6ccaac2008-07-24 23:58:27 +00006345
6346//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6347// Type Predicates.
6348//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6349
Fariborz Jahanian4fd83ea2009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006350/// getObjCGCAttr - Returns one of GCNone, Weak or Strong objc's
6351/// garbage collection attribute.
6352///
John McCallae278a32011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006353Qualifiers::GC ASTContext::getObjCGCAttrKind(QualType Ty) const {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006354 if (getLangOpts().getGC() == LangOptions::NonGC)
John McCallae278a32011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006355 return Qualifiers::GCNone;
6356
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006357 assert(getLangOpts().ObjC1);
John McCallae278a32011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006358 Qualifiers::GC GCAttrs = Ty.getObjCGCAttr();
6359
6360 // Default behaviour under objective-C's gc is for ObjC pointers
6361 // (or pointers to them) be treated as though they were declared
6362 // as __strong.
6363 if (GCAttrs == Qualifiers::GCNone) {
6364 if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
6365 return Qualifiers::Strong;
6366 else if (Ty->isPointerType())
6367 return getObjCGCAttrKind(Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
6368 } else {
6369 // It's not valid to set GC attributes on anything that isn't a
6370 // pointer.
6371#ifndef NDEBUG
6372 QualType CT = Ty->getCanonicalTypeInternal();
6373 while (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CT))
6374 CT = AT->getElementType();
6375 assert(CT->isAnyPointerType() || CT->isBlockPointerType());
6376#endif
Fariborz Jahanian4fd83ea2009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006377 }
Chris Lattnerb7d25532009-02-18 22:53:11 +00006378 return GCAttrs;
Fariborz Jahanian4fd83ea2009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006379}
6380
Chris Lattner6ac46a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006381//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6382// Type Compatibility Testing
6383//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner770951b2007-11-01 05:03:41 +00006384
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006385/// areCompatVectorTypes - Return true if the two specified vector types are
Chris Lattner6ac46a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006386/// compatible.
6387static bool areCompatVectorTypes(const VectorType *LHS,
6388 const VectorType *RHS) {
John McCall467b27b2009-10-22 20:10:53 +00006389 assert(LHS->isCanonicalUnqualified() && RHS->isCanonicalUnqualified());
Chris Lattner6ac46a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006390 return LHS->getElementType() == RHS->getElementType() &&
Chris Lattner61710852008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006391 LHS->getNumElements() == RHS->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner6ac46a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006392}
6393
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006394bool ASTContext::areCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType FirstVec,
6395 QualType SecondVec) {
6396 assert(FirstVec->isVectorType() && "FirstVec should be a vector type");
6397 assert(SecondVec->isVectorType() && "SecondVec should be a vector type");
6398
6399 if (hasSameUnqualifiedType(FirstVec, SecondVec))
6400 return true;
6401
Bob Wilsonf69eb7c2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006402 // Treat Neon vector types and most AltiVec vector types as if they are the
6403 // equivalent GCC vector types.
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006404 const VectorType *First = FirstVec->getAs<VectorType>();
6405 const VectorType *Second = SecondVec->getAs<VectorType>();
Bob Wilsonf69eb7c2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006406 if (First->getNumElements() == Second->getNumElements() &&
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006407 hasSameType(First->getElementType(), Second->getElementType()) &&
Bob Wilsonf69eb7c2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006408 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6409 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool &&
6410 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6411 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool)
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006412 return true;
6413
6414 return false;
6415}
6416
Steve Naroff4084c302009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006417//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6418// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - Compatibility testing for qualified id's.
6419//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6420
6421/// ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol - return 'true' if 'lProto' is in the
6422/// inheritance hierarchy of 'rProto'.
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006423bool
6424ASTContext::ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(ObjCProtocolDecl *lProto,
6425 ObjCProtocolDecl *rProto) const {
Douglas Gregor3fc73ee2012-01-01 18:09:12 +00006426 if (declaresSameEntity(lProto, rProto))
Steve Naroff4084c302009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006427 return true;
6428 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator PI = rProto->protocol_begin(),
6429 E = rProto->protocol_end(); PI != E; ++PI)
6430 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lProto, *PI))
6431 return true;
6432 return false;
6433}
6434
Dmitri Gribenko4c3b8a32012-08-28 02:49:14 +00006435/// ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible - compare Class<pr,...> and
6436/// Class<pr1, ...>.
Fariborz Jahaniana8f8dac2010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006437bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs,
6438 QualType rhs) {
6439 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6440 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6441 assert ((lhsQID && rhsOPT) && "ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible");
6442
6443 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = lhsQID->qual_begin(),
6444 E = lhsQID->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
6445 bool match = false;
6446 ObjCProtocolDecl *lhsProto = *I;
6447 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator J = rhsOPT->qual_begin(),
6448 E = rhsOPT->qual_end(); J != E; ++J) {
6449 ObjCProtocolDecl *rhsProto = *J;
6450 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto)) {
6451 match = true;
6452 break;
6453 }
6454 }
6455 if (!match)
6456 return false;
6457 }
6458 return true;
6459}
6460
Steve Naroff4084c302009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006461/// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - We know that one of lhs/rhs is an
6462/// ObjCQualifiedIDType.
6463bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
6464 bool compare) {
6465 // Allow id<P..> and an 'id' or void* type in all cases.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006466 if (lhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff4084c302009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006467 lhs->isObjCIdType() || lhs->isObjCClassType())
6468 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006469 else if (rhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff4084c302009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006470 rhs->isObjCIdType() || rhs->isObjCClassType())
6471 return true;
6472
6473 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006474 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006475
Steve Naroff4084c302009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006476 if (!rhsOPT) return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006477
Steve Naroff4084c302009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006478 if (rhsOPT->qual_empty()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006479 // If the RHS is a unqualified interface pointer "NSString*",
Steve Naroff4084c302009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006480 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6481 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
6482 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = lhsQID->qual_begin(),
6483 E = lhsQID->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
6484 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6485 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6486 // through its super class and categories.
Fariborz Jahanian0fd89042009-08-11 22:02:25 +00006487 if (!rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(*I, true))
Steve Naroff4084c302009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006488 return false;
6489 }
6490 }
6491 // If there are no qualifiers and no interface, we have an 'id'.
6492 return true;
6493 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006494 // Both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Steve Naroff4084c302009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006495 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = lhsQID->qual_begin(),
6496 E = lhsQID->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
6497 ObjCProtocolDecl *lhsProto = *I;
6498 bool match = false;
6499
6500 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6501 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6502 // through its super class and categories.
6503 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator J = rhsOPT->qual_begin(),
6504 E = rhsOPT->qual_end(); J != E; ++J) {
6505 ObjCProtocolDecl *rhsProto = *J;
6506 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6507 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6508 match = true;
6509 break;
6510 }
6511 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006512 // If the RHS is a qualified interface pointer "NSString<P>*",
Steve Naroff4084c302009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006513 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6514 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
6515 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = lhsQID->qual_begin(),
6516 E = lhsQID->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
6517 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6518 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6519 // through its super class and categories.
Fariborz Jahanian0fd89042009-08-11 22:02:25 +00006520 if (rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(*I, true)) {
Steve Naroff4084c302009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006521 match = true;
6522 break;
6523 }
6524 }
6525 }
6526 if (!match)
6527 return false;
6528 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006529
Steve Naroff4084c302009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006530 return true;
6531 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006532
Steve Naroff4084c302009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006533 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsQID = rhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType();
6534 assert(rhsQID && "One of the LHS/RHS should be id<x>");
6535
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006536 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT =
Steve Naroff4084c302009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006537 lhs->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniande5b17e2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006538 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Steve Naroff4084c302009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006539 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = lhsOPT->qual_begin(),
6540 E = lhsOPT->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
6541 ObjCProtocolDecl *lhsProto = *I;
6542 bool match = false;
6543
Fariborz Jahaniande5b17e2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006544 // when comparing an id<P> on rhs with a static type on lhs,
Steve Naroff4084c302009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006545 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6546 // through its super class and categories.
Fariborz Jahaniande5b17e2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006547 // First, lhs protocols in the qualifier list must be found, direct
6548 // or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
Steve Naroff4084c302009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006549 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator J = rhsQID->qual_begin(),
6550 E = rhsQID->qual_end(); J != E; ++J) {
6551 ObjCProtocolDecl *rhsProto = *J;
6552 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6553 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6554 match = true;
6555 break;
6556 }
6557 }
6558 if (!match)
6559 return false;
6560 }
Fariborz Jahaniande5b17e2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006561
6562 // Static class's protocols, or its super class or category protocols
6563 // must be found, direct or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
6564 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *lhsID = lhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
6565 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
6566 CollectInheritedProtocols(lhsID, LHSInheritedProtocols);
6567 // This is rather dubious but matches gcc's behavior. If lhs has
6568 // no type qualifier and its class has no static protocol(s)
6569 // assume that it is mismatch.
6570 if (LHSInheritedProtocols.empty() && lhsOPT->qual_empty())
6571 return false;
6572 for (llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*,8>::iterator I =
6573 LHSInheritedProtocols.begin(),
6574 E = LHSInheritedProtocols.end(); I != E; ++I) {
6575 bool match = false;
6576 ObjCProtocolDecl *lhsProto = (*I);
6577 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator J = rhsQID->qual_begin(),
6578 E = rhsQID->qual_end(); J != E; ++J) {
6579 ObjCProtocolDecl *rhsProto = *J;
6580 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6581 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6582 match = true;
6583 break;
6584 }
6585 }
6586 if (!match)
6587 return false;
6588 }
6589 }
Steve Naroff4084c302009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006590 return true;
6591 }
6592 return false;
6593}
6594
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006595/// canAssignObjCInterfaces - Return true if the two interface types are
Chris Lattner6ac46a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006596/// compatible for assignment from RHS to LHS. This handles validation of any
6597/// protocol qualifiers on the LHS or RHS.
6598///
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006599bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6600 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT) {
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006601 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
6602 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
6603
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00006604 // If either type represents the built-in 'id' or 'Class' types, return true.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006605 if (LHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass() ||
6606 RHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006607 return true;
6608
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006609 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedId() || RHS->isObjCQualifiedId())
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006610 return ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6611 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
Steve Naroff4084c302009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006612 false);
Fariborz Jahaniana8f8dac2010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006613
6614 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedClass() && RHS->isObjCQualifiedClass())
6615 return ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6616 QualType(RHSOPT,0));
6617
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006618 // If we have 2 user-defined types, fall into that path.
6619 if (LHS->getInterface() && RHS->getInterface())
Steve Naroff4084c302009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006620 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006621
Steve Naroff4084c302009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006622 return false;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006623}
6624
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006625/// canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer - This routine is specifically written
Chris Lattnerfc8f0e12011-04-15 05:22:18 +00006626/// for providing type-safety for objective-c pointers used to pass/return
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006627/// arguments in block literals. When passed as arguments, passing 'A*' where
6628/// 'id' is expected is not OK. Passing 'Sub *" where 'Super *" is expected is
6629/// not OK. For the return type, the opposite is not OK.
6630bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
6631 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
Fariborz Jahaniana4fdbfa2011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006632 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
6633 bool BlockReturnType) {
Fariborz Jahaniana9834482010-04-06 17:23:39 +00006634 if (RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || LHSOPT->isObjCIdType())
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006635 return true;
6636
6637 if (LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
6638 return RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType();
6639 }
6640
Fariborz Jahaniana9834482010-04-06 17:23:39 +00006641 if (LHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006642 return ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6643 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
6644 false);
6645
6646 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = LHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
6647 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = RHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
6648 if (LHS && RHS) { // We have 2 user-defined types.
6649 if (LHS != RHS) {
6650 if (LHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getDecl()))
Fariborz Jahaniana4fdbfa2011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006651 return BlockReturnType;
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006652 if (RHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(LHS->getDecl()))
Fariborz Jahaniana4fdbfa2011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006653 return !BlockReturnType;
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006654 }
6655 else
6656 return true;
6657 }
6658 return false;
6659}
6660
Fariborz Jahaniane23fa2d2009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006661/// getIntersectionOfProtocols - This routine finds the intersection of set
6662/// of protocols inherited from two distinct objective-c pointer objects.
6663/// It is used to build composite qualifier list of the composite type of
6664/// the conditional expression involving two objective-c pointer objects.
6665static
6666void getIntersectionOfProtocols(ASTContext &Context,
6667 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6668 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006669 SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &IntersectionOfProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahaniane23fa2d2009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006670
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006671 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
6672 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
6673 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS must have an interface base");
6674 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS must have an interface base");
Fariborz Jahaniane23fa2d2009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006675
6676 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocolSet;
6677 unsigned LHSNumProtocols = LHS->getNumProtocols();
6678 if (LHSNumProtocols > 0)
6679 InheritedProtocolSet.insert(LHS->qual_begin(), LHS->qual_end());
6680 else {
Fariborz Jahanian432a8892010-02-12 19:27:33 +00006681 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006682 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(LHS->getInterface(),
6683 LHSInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahaniane23fa2d2009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006684 InheritedProtocolSet.insert(LHSInheritedProtocols.begin(),
6685 LHSInheritedProtocols.end());
6686 }
6687
6688 unsigned RHSNumProtocols = RHS->getNumProtocols();
6689 if (RHSNumProtocols > 0) {
Dan Gohmancb421fa2010-04-19 16:39:44 +00006690 ObjCProtocolDecl **RHSProtocols =
6691 const_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl **>(RHS->qual_begin());
Fariborz Jahaniane23fa2d2009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006692 for (unsigned i = 0; i < RHSNumProtocols; ++i)
6693 if (InheritedProtocolSet.count(RHSProtocols[i]))
6694 IntersectionOfProtocols.push_back(RHSProtocols[i]);
Chad Rosier30601782011-08-17 23:08:45 +00006695 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian432a8892010-02-12 19:27:33 +00006696 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> RHSInheritedProtocols;
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006697 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(),
6698 RHSInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahanian432a8892010-02-12 19:27:33 +00006699 for (llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*,8>::iterator I =
6700 RHSInheritedProtocols.begin(),
6701 E = RHSInheritedProtocols.end(); I != E; ++I)
6702 if (InheritedProtocolSet.count((*I)))
6703 IntersectionOfProtocols.push_back((*I));
Fariborz Jahaniane23fa2d2009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006704 }
6705}
6706
Fariborz Jahaniandb07b3f2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00006707/// areCommonBaseCompatible - Returns common base class of the two classes if
6708/// one found. Note that this is O'2 algorithm. But it will be called as the
6709/// last type comparison in a ?-exp of ObjC pointer types before a
6710/// warning is issued. So, its invokation is extremely rare.
6711QualType ASTContext::areCommonBaseCompatible(
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006712 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Lptr,
6713 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Rptr) {
6714 const ObjCObjectType *LHS = Lptr->getObjectType();
6715 const ObjCObjectType *RHS = Rptr->getObjectType();
6716 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* LDecl = LHS->getInterface();
6717 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* RDecl = RHS->getInterface();
Douglas Gregor60ef3082011-12-15 00:29:59 +00006718 if (!LDecl || !RDecl || (declaresSameEntity(LDecl, RDecl)))
Fariborz Jahaniandb07b3f2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00006719 return QualType();
6720
Fariborz Jahanian7c2bdcb2011-04-18 21:16:59 +00006721 do {
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006722 LHS = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(getObjCInterfaceType(LDecl));
Fariborz Jahaniane23fa2d2009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006723 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS)) {
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006724 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006725 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, Lptr, Rptr, Protocols);
6726
6727 QualType Result = QualType(LHS, 0);
6728 if (!Protocols.empty())
6729 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, Protocols.data(), Protocols.size());
6730 Result = getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
6731 return Result;
Fariborz Jahaniane23fa2d2009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006732 }
Fariborz Jahanian7c2bdcb2011-04-18 21:16:59 +00006733 } while ((LDecl = LDecl->getSuperClass()));
Fariborz Jahaniandb07b3f2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00006734
6735 return QualType();
6736}
6737
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006738bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectType *LHS,
6739 const ObjCObjectType *RHS) {
6740 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS is not an interface type");
6741 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS is not an interface type");
6742
Chris Lattner6ac46a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006743 // Verify that the base decls are compatible: the RHS must be a subclass of
6744 // the LHS.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006745 if (!LHS->getInterface()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface()))
Chris Lattner6ac46a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006746 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006747
Chris Lattner6ac46a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006748 // RHS must have a superset of the protocols in the LHS. If the LHS is not
6749 // protocol qualified at all, then we are good.
Steve Naroffc15cb2a2009-07-18 15:33:26 +00006750 if (LHS->getNumProtocols() == 0)
Chris Lattner6ac46a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006751 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006752
Fariborz Jahanianb7bc34a2011-04-08 18:25:29 +00006753 // Okay, we know the LHS has protocol qualifiers. If the RHS doesn't,
6754 // more detailed analysis is required.
6755 if (RHS->getNumProtocols() == 0) {
6756 // OK, if LHS is a superclass of RHS *and*
6757 // this superclass is assignment compatible with LHS.
6758 // false otherwise.
Fariborz Jahanian627788c2011-04-12 16:34:14 +00006759 bool IsSuperClass =
6760 LHS->getInterface()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface());
6761 if (IsSuperClass) {
Fariborz Jahanianb7bc34a2011-04-08 18:25:29 +00006762 // OK if conversion of LHS to SuperClass results in narrowing of types
6763 // ; i.e., SuperClass may implement at least one of the protocols
6764 // in LHS's protocol list. Example, SuperObj<P1> = lhs<P1,P2> is ok.
6765 // But not SuperObj<P1,P2,P3> = lhs<P1,P2>.
6766 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> SuperClassInheritedProtocols;
Fariborz Jahanian627788c2011-04-12 16:34:14 +00006767 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahanianb7bc34a2011-04-08 18:25:29 +00006768 // If super class has no protocols, it is not a match.
6769 if (SuperClassInheritedProtocols.empty())
6770 return false;
6771
6772 for (ObjCObjectType::qual_iterator LHSPI = LHS->qual_begin(),
6773 LHSPE = LHS->qual_end();
6774 LHSPI != LHSPE; LHSPI++) {
6775 bool SuperImplementsProtocol = false;
6776 ObjCProtocolDecl *LHSProto = (*LHSPI);
6777
6778 for (llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*,8>::iterator I =
6779 SuperClassInheritedProtocols.begin(),
6780 E = SuperClassInheritedProtocols.end(); I != E; ++I) {
6781 ObjCProtocolDecl *SuperClassProto = (*I);
6782 if (SuperClassProto->lookupProtocolNamed(LHSProto->getIdentifier())) {
6783 SuperImplementsProtocol = true;
6784 break;
6785 }
6786 }
6787 if (!SuperImplementsProtocol)
6788 return false;
6789 }
6790 return true;
6791 }
6792 return false;
6793 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006794
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006795 for (ObjCObjectType::qual_iterator LHSPI = LHS->qual_begin(),
6796 LHSPE = LHS->qual_end();
Steve Naroff91b0b0c2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006797 LHSPI != LHSPE; LHSPI++) {
6798 bool RHSImplementsProtocol = false;
6799
6800 // If the RHS doesn't implement the protocol on the left, the types
6801 // are incompatible.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006802 for (ObjCObjectType::qual_iterator RHSPI = RHS->qual_begin(),
6803 RHSPE = RHS->qual_end();
Steve Naroff8f167562009-07-16 16:21:02 +00006804 RHSPI != RHSPE; RHSPI++) {
6805 if ((*RHSPI)->lookupProtocolNamed((*LHSPI)->getIdentifier())) {
Steve Naroff91b0b0c2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006806 RHSImplementsProtocol = true;
Steve Naroff8f167562009-07-16 16:21:02 +00006807 break;
6808 }
Steve Naroff91b0b0c2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006809 }
6810 // FIXME: For better diagnostics, consider passing back the protocol name.
6811 if (!RHSImplementsProtocol)
6812 return false;
Chris Lattner6ac46a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006813 }
Steve Naroff91b0b0c2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006814 // The RHS implements all protocols listed on the LHS.
6815 return true;
Chris Lattner6ac46a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006816}
6817
Steve Naroff389bf462009-02-12 17:52:19 +00006818bool ASTContext::areComparableObjCPointerTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
6819 // get the "pointed to" types
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006820 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6821 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006822
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006823 if (!LHSOPT || !RHSOPT)
Steve Naroff389bf462009-02-12 17:52:19 +00006824 return false;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006825
6826 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT) ||
6827 canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT);
Steve Naroff389bf462009-02-12 17:52:19 +00006828}
6829
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00006830bool ASTContext::canBindObjCObjectType(QualType To, QualType From) {
6831 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(
6832 getObjCObjectPointerType(To)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
6833 getObjCObjectPointerType(From)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>());
6834}
6835
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006836/// typesAreCompatible - C99 6.7.3p9: For two qualified types to be compatible,
Steve Naroffec0550f2007-10-15 20:41:53 +00006837/// both shall have the identically qualified version of a compatible type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006838/// C99 6.2.7p1: Two types have compatible types if their types are the
Steve Naroffec0550f2007-10-15 20:41:53 +00006839/// same. See 6.7.[2,3,5] for additional rules.
Douglas Gregor447234d2010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006840bool ASTContext::typesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
6841 bool CompareUnqualified) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006842 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor0e709ab2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00006843 return hasSameType(LHS, RHS);
6844
Douglas Gregor447234d2010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006845 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, false, CompareUnqualified).isNull();
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006846}
6847
Fariborz Jahanianc286f382011-07-12 22:05:16 +00006848bool ASTContext::propertyTypesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
Fariborz Jahanian82378392011-07-12 23:20:13 +00006849 return typesAreCompatible(LHS, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianc286f382011-07-12 22:05:16 +00006850}
6851
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006852bool ASTContext::typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
6853 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true).isNull();
6854}
6855
Peter Collingbourne48466752010-10-24 18:30:18 +00006856/// mergeTransparentUnionType - if T is a transparent union type and a member
6857/// of T is compatible with SubType, return the merged type, else return
6858/// QualType()
6859QualType ASTContext::mergeTransparentUnionType(QualType T, QualType SubType,
6860 bool OfBlockPointer,
6861 bool Unqualified) {
6862 if (const RecordType *UT = T->getAsUnionType()) {
6863 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
6864 if (UD->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) {
6865 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
6866 itend = UD->field_end(); it != itend; ++it) {
Peter Collingbournef91d7572010-12-02 21:00:06 +00006867 QualType ET = it->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
Peter Collingbourne48466752010-10-24 18:30:18 +00006868 QualType MT = mergeTypes(ET, SubType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
6869 if (!MT.isNull())
6870 return MT;
6871 }
6872 }
6873 }
6874
6875 return QualType();
6876}
6877
6878/// mergeFunctionArgumentTypes - merge two types which appear as function
6879/// argument types
6880QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionArgumentTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
6881 bool OfBlockPointer,
6882 bool Unqualified) {
6883 // GNU extension: two types are compatible if they appear as a function
6884 // argument, one of the types is a transparent union type and the other
6885 // type is compatible with a union member
6886 QualType lmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer,
6887 Unqualified);
6888 if (!lmerge.isNull())
6889 return lmerge;
6890
6891 QualType rmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(rhs, lhs, OfBlockPointer,
6892 Unqualified);
6893 if (!rmerge.isNull())
6894 return rmerge;
6895
6896 return mergeTypes(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
6897}
6898
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006899QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
Douglas Gregor447234d2010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006900 bool OfBlockPointer,
6901 bool Unqualified) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006902 const FunctionType *lbase = lhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
6903 const FunctionType *rbase = rhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00006904 const FunctionProtoType *lproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(lbase);
6905 const FunctionProtoType *rproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(rbase);
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006906 bool allLTypes = true;
6907 bool allRTypes = true;
6908
6909 // Check return type
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006910 QualType retType;
Fariborz Jahaniand263fd12011-02-11 18:46:17 +00006911 if (OfBlockPointer) {
6912 QualType RHS = rbase->getResultType();
6913 QualType LHS = lbase->getResultType();
6914 bool UnqualifiedResult = Unqualified;
6915 if (!UnqualifiedResult)
6916 UnqualifiedResult = (!RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers());
Fariborz Jahaniana4fdbfa2011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006917 retType = mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true, UnqualifiedResult, true);
Fariborz Jahaniand263fd12011-02-11 18:46:17 +00006918 }
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006919 else
John McCall8cc246c2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006920 retType = mergeTypes(lbase->getResultType(), rbase->getResultType(), false,
6921 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006922 if (retType.isNull()) return QualType();
Douglas Gregor447234d2010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006923
6924 if (Unqualified)
6925 retType = retType.getUnqualifiedType();
6926
6927 CanQualType LRetType = getCanonicalType(lbase->getResultType());
6928 CanQualType RRetType = getCanonicalType(rbase->getResultType());
6929 if (Unqualified) {
6930 LRetType = LRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
6931 RRetType = RRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
6932 }
6933
6934 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != LRetType)
Chris Lattner61710852008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006935 allLTypes = false;
Douglas Gregor447234d2010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006936 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != RRetType)
Chris Lattner61710852008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006937 allRTypes = false;
John McCall8cc246c2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006938
Daniel Dunbar6a15c852010-04-28 16:20:58 +00006939 // FIXME: double check this
6940 // FIXME: should we error if lbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
6941 // rbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
6942 // lbase->getRegParmAttr() != rbase->getRegParmAttr()?
Rafael Espindola264ba482010-03-30 20:24:48 +00006943 FunctionType::ExtInfo lbaseInfo = lbase->getExtInfo();
6944 FunctionType::ExtInfo rbaseInfo = rbase->getExtInfo();
John McCall8cc246c2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006945
Douglas Gregorab8bbf42010-01-18 17:14:39 +00006946 // Compatible functions must have compatible calling conventions
John McCall8cc246c2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006947 if (!isSameCallConv(lbaseInfo.getCC(), rbaseInfo.getCC()))
Douglas Gregorab8bbf42010-01-18 17:14:39 +00006948 return QualType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006949
John McCall8cc246c2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006950 // Regparm is part of the calling convention.
Eli Friedmana49218e2011-04-09 08:18:08 +00006951 if (lbaseInfo.getHasRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getHasRegParm())
6952 return QualType();
John McCall8cc246c2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006953 if (lbaseInfo.getRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getRegParm())
6954 return QualType();
6955
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006956 if (lbaseInfo.getProducesResult() != rbaseInfo.getProducesResult())
6957 return QualType();
6958
John McCall8cc246c2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006959 // FIXME: some uses, e.g. conditional exprs, really want this to be 'both'.
6960 bool NoReturn = lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() || rbaseInfo.getNoReturn();
John McCall8cc246c2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006961
Rafael Espindola8b8a09e2012-11-29 16:09:03 +00006962 if (lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
6963 allLTypes = false;
6964 if (rbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
6965 allRTypes = false;
6966
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006967 FunctionType::ExtInfo einfo = lbaseInfo.withNoReturn(NoReturn);
John McCalle23cf432010-12-14 08:05:40 +00006968
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006969 if (lproto && rproto) { // two C99 style function prototypes
Sebastian Redl465226e2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00006970 assert(!lproto->hasExceptionSpec() && !rproto->hasExceptionSpec() &&
6971 "C++ shouldn't be here");
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006972 unsigned lproto_nargs = lproto->getNumArgs();
6973 unsigned rproto_nargs = rproto->getNumArgs();
6974
6975 // Compatible functions must have the same number of arguments
6976 if (lproto_nargs != rproto_nargs)
6977 return QualType();
6978
6979 // Variadic and non-variadic functions aren't compatible
6980 if (lproto->isVariadic() != rproto->isVariadic())
6981 return QualType();
6982
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7fb5e482008-10-26 16:43:14 +00006983 if (lproto->getTypeQuals() != rproto->getTypeQuals())
6984 return QualType();
6985
Fariborz Jahanian78213e42011-09-28 21:52:05 +00006986 if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount &&
6987 !FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(rproto, lproto))
6988 return QualType();
6989
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006990 // Check argument compatibility
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006991 SmallVector<QualType, 10> types;
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006992 for (unsigned i = 0; i < lproto_nargs; i++) {
6993 QualType largtype = lproto->getArgType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
6994 QualType rargtype = rproto->getArgType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
Peter Collingbourne48466752010-10-24 18:30:18 +00006995 QualType argtype = mergeFunctionArgumentTypes(largtype, rargtype,
6996 OfBlockPointer,
6997 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006998 if (argtype.isNull()) return QualType();
Douglas Gregor447234d2010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006999
7000 if (Unqualified)
7001 argtype = argtype.getUnqualifiedType();
7002
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007003 types.push_back(argtype);
Douglas Gregor447234d2010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007004 if (Unqualified) {
7005 largtype = largtype.getUnqualifiedType();
7006 rargtype = rargtype.getUnqualifiedType();
7007 }
7008
Chris Lattner61710852008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007009 if (getCanonicalType(argtype) != getCanonicalType(largtype))
7010 allLTypes = false;
7011 if (getCanonicalType(argtype) != getCanonicalType(rargtype))
7012 allRTypes = false;
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007013 }
Fariborz Jahanian78213e42011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007014
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007015 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7016 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalle23cf432010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007017
7018 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = lproto->getExtProtoInfo();
7019 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Jordan Rosebea522f2013-03-08 21:51:21 +00007020 return getFunctionType(retType, types, EPI);
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007021 }
7022
7023 if (lproto) allRTypes = false;
7024 if (rproto) allLTypes = false;
7025
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007026 const FunctionProtoType *proto = lproto ? lproto : rproto;
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007027 if (proto) {
Sebastian Redl465226e2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00007028 assert(!proto->hasExceptionSpec() && "C++ shouldn't be here");
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007029 if (proto->isVariadic()) return QualType();
7030 // Check that the types are compatible with the types that
7031 // would result from default argument promotions (C99 6.7.5.3p15).
7032 // The only types actually affected are promotable integer
7033 // types and floats, which would be passed as a different
7034 // type depending on whether the prototype is visible.
7035 unsigned proto_nargs = proto->getNumArgs();
7036 for (unsigned i = 0; i < proto_nargs; ++i) {
7037 QualType argTy = proto->getArgType(i);
Douglas Gregorb0f8eac2010-02-03 19:27:29 +00007038
Eli Friedmanc586d5d2012-08-30 00:44:15 +00007039 // Look at the converted type of enum types, since that is the type used
Douglas Gregorb0f8eac2010-02-03 19:27:29 +00007040 // to pass enum values.
Eli Friedmanc586d5d2012-08-30 00:44:15 +00007041 if (const EnumType *Enum = argTy->getAs<EnumType>()) {
7042 argTy = Enum->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7043 if (argTy.isNull())
7044 return QualType();
7045 }
Douglas Gregorb0f8eac2010-02-03 19:27:29 +00007046
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007047 if (argTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ||
7048 getCanonicalType(argTy).getUnqualifiedType() == FloatTy)
7049 return QualType();
7050 }
7051
7052 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7053 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalle23cf432010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007054
7055 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = proto->getExtProtoInfo();
7056 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Reid Kleckner0567a792013-06-10 20:51:09 +00007057 return getFunctionType(retType, proto->getArgTypes(), EPI);
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007058 }
7059
7060 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7061 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCall8cc246c2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007062 return getFunctionNoProtoType(retType, einfo);
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007063}
7064
John McCallb9da7132013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007065/// Given that we have an enum type and a non-enum type, try to merge them.
7066static QualType mergeEnumWithInteger(ASTContext &Context, const EnumType *ET,
7067 QualType other, bool isBlockReturnType) {
7068 // C99 6.7.2.2p4: Each enumerated type shall be compatible with char,
7069 // a signed integer type, or an unsigned integer type.
7070 // Compatibility is based on the underlying type, not the promotion
7071 // type.
7072 QualType underlyingType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7073 if (underlyingType.isNull()) return QualType();
7074 if (Context.hasSameType(underlyingType, other))
7075 return other;
7076
7077 // In block return types, we're more permissive and accept any
7078 // integral type of the same size.
7079 if (isBlockReturnType && other->isIntegerType() &&
7080 Context.getTypeSize(underlyingType) == Context.getTypeSize(other))
7081 return other;
7082
7083 return QualType();
7084}
7085
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007086QualType ASTContext::mergeTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
Douglas Gregor447234d2010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007087 bool OfBlockPointer,
Fariborz Jahaniana4fdbfa2011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007088 bool Unqualified, bool BlockReturnType) {
Bill Wendling43d69752007-12-03 07:33:35 +00007089 // C++ [expr]: If an expression initially has the type "reference to T", the
7090 // type is adjusted to "T" prior to any further analysis, the expression
7091 // designates the object or function denoted by the reference, and the
Sebastian Redl7c80bd62009-03-16 23:22:08 +00007092 // expression is an lvalue unless the reference is an rvalue reference and
7093 // the expression is a function call (possibly inside parentheses).
Douglas Gregor0e709ab2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007094 assert(!LHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "LHS is a reference type?");
7095 assert(!RHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "RHS is a reference type?");
Douglas Gregor447234d2010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007096
7097 if (Unqualified) {
7098 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7099 RHS = RHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7100 }
Douglas Gregor0e709ab2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007101
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007102 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7103 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7104
7105 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7106 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7107 return LHS;
7108
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007109 // If the qualifiers are different, the types aren't compatible... mostly.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00007110 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7111 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007112 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
7113 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type
7114 // mismatch.
7115 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007116 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace() ||
7117 LQuals.getObjCLifetime() != RQuals.getObjCLifetime())
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007118 return QualType();
7119
7120 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7121 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7122 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
7123 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7124 // qualified __strong.
7125 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7126 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7127 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7128
7129 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
7130 return QualType();
7131
7132 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7133 return mergeTypes(LHS, getObjCGCQualType(RHS, Qualifiers::Strong));
7134 }
7135 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong && LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7136 return mergeTypes(getObjCGCQualType(LHS, Qualifiers::Strong), RHS);
7137 }
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007138 return QualType();
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007139 }
7140
7141 // Okay, qualifiers are equal.
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007142
Eli Friedman852d63b2009-06-01 01:22:52 +00007143 Type::TypeClass LHSClass = LHSCan->getTypeClass();
7144 Type::TypeClass RHSClass = RHSCan->getTypeClass();
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007145
Chris Lattner1adb8832008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007146 // We want to consider the two function types to be the same for these
7147 // comparisons, just force one to the other.
7148 if (LHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) LHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
7149 if (RHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) RHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
Eli Friedman4c721d32008-02-12 08:23:06 +00007150
7151 // Same as above for arrays
Chris Lattnera36a61f2008-04-07 05:43:21 +00007152 if (LHSClass == Type::VariableArray || LHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7153 LHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
7154 if (RHSClass == Type::VariableArray || RHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7155 RHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007156
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007157 // ObjCInterfaces are just specialized ObjCObjects.
7158 if (LHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) LHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7159 if (RHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) RHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7160
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00007161 // Canonicalize ExtVector -> Vector.
7162 if (LHSClass == Type::ExtVector) LHSClass = Type::Vector;
7163 if (RHSClass == Type::ExtVector) RHSClass = Type::Vector;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007164
Chris Lattnera36a61f2008-04-07 05:43:21 +00007165 // If the canonical type classes don't match.
Chris Lattner1adb8832008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007166 if (LHSClass != RHSClass) {
John McCallb9da7132013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007167 // Note that we only have special rules for turning block enum
7168 // returns into block int returns, not vice-versa.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007169 if (const EnumType* ETy = LHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCallb9da7132013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007170 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, RHS, false);
Eli Friedmanbab96962008-02-12 08:46:17 +00007171 }
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007172 if (const EnumType* ETy = RHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCallb9da7132013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007173 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, LHS, BlockReturnType);
Eli Friedmanbab96962008-02-12 08:46:17 +00007174 }
Fariborz Jahaniane7cff2c2012-01-26 00:45:38 +00007175 // allow block pointer type to match an 'id' type.
Fariborz Jahanian41963632012-01-26 17:08:50 +00007176 if (OfBlockPointer && !BlockReturnType) {
7177 if (LHS->isObjCIdType() && RHS->isBlockPointerType())
7178 return LHS;
7179 if (RHS->isObjCIdType() && LHS->isBlockPointerType())
7180 return RHS;
7181 }
Fariborz Jahaniane7cff2c2012-01-26 00:45:38 +00007182
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007183 return QualType();
Steve Naroffec0550f2007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007184 }
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007185
Steve Naroff4a746782008-01-09 22:43:08 +00007186 // The canonical type classes match.
Chris Lattner1adb8832008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007187 switch (LHSClass) {
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007188#define TYPE(Class, Base)
7189#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
John McCallad5e7382010-03-01 23:49:17 +00007190#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007191#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7192#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7193#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007194 llvm_unreachable("Non-canonical and dependent types shouldn't get here");
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007195
Richard Smithdc7a4f52013-04-30 13:56:41 +00007196 case Type::Auto:
Sebastian Redl7c80bd62009-03-16 23:22:08 +00007197 case Type::LValueReference:
7198 case Type::RValueReference:
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007199 case Type::MemberPointer:
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007200 llvm_unreachable("C++ should never be in mergeTypes");
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007201
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007202 case Type::ObjCInterface:
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007203 case Type::IncompleteArray:
7204 case Type::VariableArray:
7205 case Type::FunctionProto:
7206 case Type::ExtVector:
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007207 llvm_unreachable("Types are eliminated above");
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007208
Chris Lattner1adb8832008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007209 case Type::Pointer:
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007210 {
7211 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00007212 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7213 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor447234d2010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007214 if (Unqualified) {
7215 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7216 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7217 }
7218 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, false,
7219 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007220 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Eli Friedman07d25872009-06-02 05:28:56 +00007221 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner61710852008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007222 return LHS;
Eli Friedman07d25872009-06-02 05:28:56 +00007223 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner61710852008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007224 return RHS;
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007225 return getPointerType(ResultType);
7226 }
Steve Naroffc0febd52008-12-10 17:49:55 +00007227 case Type::BlockPointer:
7228 {
7229 // Merge two block pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00007230 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7231 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor447234d2010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007232 if (Unqualified) {
7233 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7234 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7235 }
7236 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, OfBlockPointer,
7237 Unqualified);
Steve Naroffc0febd52008-12-10 17:49:55 +00007238 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7239 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7240 return LHS;
7241 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7242 return RHS;
7243 return getBlockPointerType(ResultType);
7244 }
Eli Friedmanb001de72011-10-06 23:00:33 +00007245 case Type::Atomic:
7246 {
7247 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
7248 QualType LHSValue = LHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7249 QualType RHSValue = RHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7250 if (Unqualified) {
7251 LHSValue = LHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7252 RHSValue = RHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7253 }
7254 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSValue, RHSValue, false,
7255 Unqualified);
7256 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7257 if (getCanonicalType(LHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7258 return LHS;
7259 if (getCanonicalType(RHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7260 return RHS;
7261 return getAtomicType(ResultType);
7262 }
Chris Lattner1adb8832008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007263 case Type::ConstantArray:
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007264 {
7265 const ConstantArrayType* LCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(LHS);
7266 const ConstantArrayType* RCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(RHS);
7267 if (LCAT && RCAT && RCAT->getSize() != LCAT->getSize())
7268 return QualType();
7269
7270 QualType LHSElem = getAsArrayType(LHS)->getElementType();
7271 QualType RHSElem = getAsArrayType(RHS)->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor447234d2010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007272 if (Unqualified) {
7273 LHSElem = LHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7274 RHSElem = RHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7275 }
7276
7277 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSElem, RHSElem, false, Unqualified);
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007278 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Chris Lattner61710852008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007279 if (LCAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7280 return LHS;
7281 if (RCAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7282 return RHS;
Eli Friedman3bc0f452008-08-22 01:48:21 +00007283 if (LCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, LCAT->getSize(),
7284 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
7285 if (RCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, RCAT->getSize(),
7286 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007287 const VariableArrayType* LVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(LHS);
7288 const VariableArrayType* RVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(RHS);
Chris Lattner61710852008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007289 if (LVAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7290 return LHS;
7291 if (RVAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7292 return RHS;
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007293 if (LVAT) {
7294 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7295 // the array's size has to be the size of LHS, but the type
7296 // has to be different.
7297 return LHS;
7298 }
7299 if (RVAT) {
7300 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7301 // the array's size has to be the size of RHS, but the type
7302 // has to be different.
7303 return RHS;
7304 }
Eli Friedman3bc0f452008-08-22 01:48:21 +00007305 if (getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return LHS;
7306 if (getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return RHS;
Douglas Gregor7e7eb3d2009-07-06 15:59:29 +00007307 return getIncompleteArrayType(ResultType,
7308 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007309 }
Chris Lattner1adb8832008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007310 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
Douglas Gregor447234d2010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007311 return mergeFunctionTypes(LHS, RHS, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007312 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007313 case Type::Enum:
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007314 return QualType();
Chris Lattner1adb8832008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007315 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner3cc4c0c2008-04-07 05:55:38 +00007316 // Only exactly equal builtin types are compatible, which is tested above.
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007317 return QualType();
Daniel Dunbar64cfdb72009-01-28 21:22:12 +00007318 case Type::Complex:
7319 // Distinct complex types are incompatible.
7320 return QualType();
Chris Lattner3cc4c0c2008-04-07 05:55:38 +00007321 case Type::Vector:
Eli Friedman5a61f0e2009-02-27 23:04:43 +00007322 // FIXME: The merged type should be an ExtVector!
John McCall1c471f32010-03-12 23:14:13 +00007323 if (areCompatVectorTypes(LHSCan->getAs<VectorType>(),
7324 RHSCan->getAs<VectorType>()))
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007325 return LHS;
Chris Lattner61710852008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007326 return QualType();
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007327 case Type::ObjCObject: {
7328 // Check if the types are assignment compatible.
Eli Friedman5a61f0e2009-02-27 23:04:43 +00007329 // FIXME: This should be type compatibility, e.g. whether
7330 // "LHS x; RHS x;" at global scope is legal.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007331 const ObjCObjectType* LHSIface = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7332 const ObjCObjectType* RHSIface = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7333 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSIface, RHSIface))
Steve Naroff5fd659d2009-02-21 16:18:07 +00007334 return LHS;
7335
Eli Friedman3d815e72008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007336 return QualType();
Cedric Venet61490e92009-02-21 17:14:49 +00007337 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007338 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007339 if (OfBlockPointer) {
7340 if (canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
7341 LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
Fariborz Jahaniana4fdbfa2011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007342 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7343 BlockReturnType))
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007344 return LHS;
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007345 return QualType();
7346 }
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007347 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7348 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()))
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007349 return LHS;
7350
Steve Naroffbc76dd02008-12-10 22:14:21 +00007351 return QualType();
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007352 }
Steve Naroffec0550f2007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007353 }
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007354
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007355 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Type::Class!");
Steve Naroffec0550f2007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007356}
Ted Kremenek7192f8e2007-10-31 17:10:13 +00007357
Fariborz Jahanian78213e42011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007358bool ASTContext::FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(
7359 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType,
7360 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType) {
7361 if (FromFunctionType->hasAnyConsumedArgs() !=
7362 ToFunctionType->hasAnyConsumedArgs())
7363 return false;
7364 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo FromEPI =
7365 FromFunctionType->getExtProtoInfo();
7366 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo ToEPI =
7367 ToFunctionType->getExtProtoInfo();
7368 if (FromEPI.ConsumedArguments && ToEPI.ConsumedArguments)
7369 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
7370 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
7371 if (FromEPI.ConsumedArguments[ArgIdx] !=
7372 ToEPI.ConsumedArguments[ArgIdx])
7373 return false;
7374 }
7375 return true;
7376}
7377
Fariborz Jahanian2390a722010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007378/// mergeObjCGCQualifiers - This routine merges ObjC's GC attribute of 'LHS' and
7379/// 'RHS' attributes and returns the merged version; including for function
7380/// return types.
7381QualType ASTContext::mergeObjCGCQualifiers(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7382 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7383 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7384 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7385 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7386 return LHS;
7387 if (RHSCan->isFunctionType()) {
7388 if (!LHSCan->isFunctionType())
7389 return QualType();
7390 QualType OldReturnType =
7391 cast<FunctionType>(RHSCan.getTypePtr())->getResultType();
7392 QualType NewReturnType =
7393 cast<FunctionType>(LHSCan.getTypePtr())->getResultType();
7394 QualType ResReturnType =
7395 mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewReturnType, OldReturnType);
7396 if (ResReturnType.isNull())
7397 return QualType();
7398 if (ResReturnType == NewReturnType || ResReturnType == OldReturnType) {
7399 // id foo(); ... __strong id foo(); or: __strong id foo(); ... id foo();
7400 // In either case, use OldReturnType to build the new function type.
7401 const FunctionType *F = LHS->getAs<FunctionType>();
7402 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(F)) {
John McCalle23cf432010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007403 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
7404 EPI.ExtInfo = getFunctionExtInfo(LHS);
Reid Kleckner0567a792013-06-10 20:51:09 +00007405 QualType ResultType =
7406 getFunctionType(OldReturnType, FPT->getArgTypes(), EPI);
Fariborz Jahanian2390a722010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007407 return ResultType;
7408 }
7409 }
7410 return QualType();
7411 }
7412
7413 // If the qualifiers are different, the types can still be merged.
7414 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7415 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7416 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
7417 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type mismatch.
7418 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
7419 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace())
7420 return QualType();
7421
7422 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7423 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7424 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
7425 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7426 // qualified __strong.
7427 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7428 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7429 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7430
7431 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
7432 return QualType();
7433
7434 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong)
7435 return LHS;
7436 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong)
7437 return RHS;
7438 return QualType();
7439 }
7440
7441 if (LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7442 QualType LHSBaseQT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7443 QualType RHSBaseQT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7444 QualType ResQT = mergeObjCGCQualifiers(LHSBaseQT, RHSBaseQT);
7445 if (ResQT == LHSBaseQT)
7446 return LHS;
7447 if (ResQT == RHSBaseQT)
7448 return RHS;
7449 }
7450 return QualType();
7451}
7452
Chris Lattner5426bf62008-04-07 07:01:58 +00007453//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Eli Friedmanad74a752008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007454// Integer Predicates
7455//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner88054de2009-01-16 07:15:35 +00007456
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007457unsigned ASTContext::getIntWidth(QualType T) const {
John McCallf4c73712011-01-19 06:33:43 +00007458 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(T))
Eli Friedman29a7f332009-12-10 22:29:29 +00007459 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00007460 if (T->isBooleanType())
7461 return 1;
Eli Friedmanf98aba32009-02-13 02:31:07 +00007462 // For builtin types, just use the standard type sizing method
Eli Friedmanad74a752008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007463 return (unsigned)getTypeSize(T);
7464}
7465
Abramo Bagnara762f1592012-09-09 10:21:24 +00007466QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingUnsignedType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00007467 assert(T->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation() && "Unexpected type");
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007468
7469 // Turn <4 x signed int> -> <4 x unsigned int>
7470 if (const VectorType *VTy = T->getAs<VectorType>())
7471 return getVectorType(getCorrespondingUnsignedType(VTy->getElementType()),
Bob Wilsone86d78c2010-11-10 21:56:12 +00007472 VTy->getNumElements(), VTy->getVectorKind());
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007473
7474 // For enums, we return the unsigned version of the base type.
7475 if (const EnumType *ETy = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedmanad74a752008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007476 T = ETy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007477
7478 const BuiltinType *BTy = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
7479 assert(BTy && "Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedmanad74a752008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007480 switch (BTy->getKind()) {
7481 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
7482 case BuiltinType::SChar:
7483 return UnsignedCharTy;
7484 case BuiltinType::Short:
7485 return UnsignedShortTy;
7486 case BuiltinType::Int:
7487 return UnsignedIntTy;
7488 case BuiltinType::Long:
7489 return UnsignedLongTy;
7490 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
7491 return UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner2df9ced2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00007492 case BuiltinType::Int128:
7493 return UnsignedInt128Ty;
Eli Friedmanad74a752008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007494 default:
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007495 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedmanad74a752008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007496 }
7497}
7498
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7b903402010-10-24 17:26:36 +00007499ASTMutationListener::~ASTMutationListener() { }
7500
Richard Smith9dadfab2013-05-11 05:45:24 +00007501void ASTMutationListener::DeducedReturnType(const FunctionDecl *FD,
7502 QualType ReturnType) {}
Chris Lattner86df27b2009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007503
7504//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7505// Builtin Type Computation
7506//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7507
7508/// DecodeTypeFromStr - This decodes one type descriptor from Str, advancing the
Chris Lattner33daae62010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007509/// pointer over the consumed characters. This returns the resultant type. If
7510/// AllowTypeModifiers is false then modifier like * are not parsed, just basic
7511/// types. This allows "v2i*" to be parsed as a pointer to a v2i instead of
7512/// a vector of "i*".
Chris Lattner14e0e742010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007513///
7514/// RequiresICE is filled in on return to indicate whether the value is required
7515/// to be an Integer Constant Expression.
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007516static QualType DecodeTypeFromStr(const char *&Str, const ASTContext &Context,
Chris Lattner86df27b2009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007517 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Chris Lattner14e0e742010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007518 bool &RequiresICE,
Chris Lattner33daae62010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007519 bool AllowTypeModifiers) {
Chris Lattner86df27b2009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007520 // Modifiers.
7521 int HowLong = 0;
7522 bool Signed = false, Unsigned = false;
Chris Lattner14e0e742010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007523 RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattner393bd8e2010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007524
Chris Lattner33daae62010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007525 // Read the prefixed modifiers first.
Chris Lattner86df27b2009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007526 bool Done = false;
7527 while (!Done) {
7528 switch (*Str++) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007529 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
Chris Lattner393bd8e2010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007530 case 'I':
Chris Lattner14e0e742010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007531 RequiresICE = true;
Chris Lattner393bd8e2010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007532 break;
Chris Lattner86df27b2009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007533 case 'S':
7534 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
7535 assert(!Signed && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!");
7536 Signed = true;
7537 break;
7538 case 'U':
7539 assert(!Signed && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
7540 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!");
7541 Unsigned = true;
7542 break;
7543 case 'L':
7544 assert(HowLong <= 2 && "Can't have LLLL modifier");
7545 ++HowLong;
7546 break;
7547 }
7548 }
7549
7550 QualType Type;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007551
Chris Lattner86df27b2009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007552 // Read the base type.
7553 switch (*Str++) {
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007554 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type letter!");
Chris Lattner86df27b2009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007555 case 'v':
7556 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7557 "Bad modifiers used with 'v'!");
7558 Type = Context.VoidTy;
7559 break;
Jack Carter146522e2013-08-15 15:16:57 +00007560 case 'h':
7561 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7562 "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!");
7563 Type = Context.HalfTy;
7564 break;
Chris Lattner86df27b2009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007565 case 'f':
7566 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7567 "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!");
7568 Type = Context.FloatTy;
7569 break;
7570 case 'd':
7571 assert(HowLong < 2 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7572 "Bad modifiers used with 'd'!");
7573 if (HowLong)
7574 Type = Context.LongDoubleTy;
7575 else
7576 Type = Context.DoubleTy;
7577 break;
7578 case 's':
7579 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 's'!");
7580 if (Unsigned)
7581 Type = Context.UnsignedShortTy;
7582 else
7583 Type = Context.ShortTy;
7584 break;
7585 case 'i':
7586 if (HowLong == 3)
7587 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedInt128Ty : Context.Int128Ty;
7588 else if (HowLong == 2)
7589 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy;
7590 else if (HowLong == 1)
7591 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy;
7592 else
7593 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy;
7594 break;
7595 case 'c':
7596 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 'c'!");
7597 if (Signed)
7598 Type = Context.SignedCharTy;
7599 else if (Unsigned)
7600 Type = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
7601 else
7602 Type = Context.CharTy;
7603 break;
7604 case 'b': // boolean
7605 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'b'!");
7606 Type = Context.BoolTy;
7607 break;
7608 case 'z': // size_t.
7609 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'z'!");
7610 Type = Context.getSizeType();
7611 break;
7612 case 'F':
7613 Type = Context.getCFConstantStringType();
7614 break;
Fariborz Jahanianba8bda02010-11-09 21:38:20 +00007615 case 'G':
7616 Type = Context.getObjCIdType();
7617 break;
7618 case 'H':
7619 Type = Context.getObjCSelType();
7620 break;
Fariborz Jahanianf7992132013-01-04 18:45:40 +00007621 case 'M':
7622 Type = Context.getObjCSuperType();
7623 break;
Chris Lattner86df27b2009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007624 case 'a':
7625 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
7626 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
7627 break;
7628 case 'A':
7629 // This is a "reference" to a va_list; however, what exactly
7630 // this means depends on how va_list is defined. There are two
7631 // different kinds of va_list: ones passed by value, and ones
7632 // passed by reference. An example of a by-value va_list is
7633 // x86, where va_list is a char*. An example of by-ref va_list
7634 // is x86-64, where va_list is a __va_list_tag[1]. For x86,
7635 // we want this argument to be a char*&; for x86-64, we want
7636 // it to be a __va_list_tag*.
7637 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
7638 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
Chris Lattner14e0e742010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007639 if (Type->isArrayType())
Chris Lattner86df27b2009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007640 Type = Context.getArrayDecayedType(Type);
Chris Lattner14e0e742010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007641 else
Chris Lattner86df27b2009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007642 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
Chris Lattner86df27b2009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007643 break;
7644 case 'V': {
7645 char *End;
Chris Lattner86df27b2009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007646 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7647 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
Chris Lattner86df27b2009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007648 Str = End;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007649
Chris Lattner14e0e742010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007650 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error,
7651 RequiresICE, false);
7652 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require vector ICE");
Chris Lattner33daae62010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007653
7654 // TODO: No way to make AltiVec vectors in builtins yet.
Chris Lattner788b0fd2010-06-23 06:00:24 +00007655 Type = Context.getVectorType(ElementType, NumElements,
Bob Wilsone86d78c2010-11-10 21:56:12 +00007656 VectorType::GenericVector);
Chris Lattner86df27b2009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007657 break;
7658 }
Douglas Gregorb4bc99b2012-06-07 18:08:25 +00007659 case 'E': {
7660 char *End;
7661
7662 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7663 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
7664
7665 Str = End;
7666
7667 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
7668 false);
7669 Type = Context.getExtVectorType(ElementType, NumElements);
7670 break;
7671 }
Douglas Gregord3a23b22009-09-28 21:45:01 +00007672 case 'X': {
Chris Lattner14e0e742010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007673 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
7674 false);
7675 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require complex ICE");
Douglas Gregord3a23b22009-09-28 21:45:01 +00007676 Type = Context.getComplexType(ElementType);
7677 break;
Fariborz Jahaniancc075e42011-08-23 23:33:09 +00007678 }
7679 case 'Y' : {
7680 Type = Context.getPointerDiffType();
7681 break;
7682 }
Chris Lattner9a5a7e72009-07-28 22:49:34 +00007683 case 'P':
Douglas Gregorc29f77b2009-07-07 16:35:42 +00007684 Type = Context.getFILEType();
7685 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stumpf711c412009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007686 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio;
Chris Lattner86df27b2009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007687 return QualType();
7688 }
Mike Stumpfd612db2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00007689 break;
Chris Lattner9a5a7e72009-07-28 22:49:34 +00007690 case 'J':
Mike Stumpf711c412009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007691 if (Signed)
Mike Stump782fa302009-07-28 02:25:19 +00007692 Type = Context.getsigjmp_bufType();
Mike Stumpf711c412009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007693 else
7694 Type = Context.getjmp_bufType();
7695
Mike Stumpfd612db2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00007696 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stumpf711c412009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007697 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp;
Mike Stumpfd612db2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00007698 return QualType();
7699 }
7700 break;
Rafael Espindolae2d4f4e2011-11-13 21:51:09 +00007701 case 'K':
7702 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'K'!");
7703 Type = Context.getucontext_tType();
7704
7705 if (Type.isNull()) {
7706 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext;
7707 return QualType();
7708 }
7709 break;
Eli Friedman6902e412012-11-27 02:58:24 +00007710 case 'p':
7711 Type = Context.getProcessIDType();
7712 break;
Mike Stump782fa302009-07-28 02:25:19 +00007713 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007714
Chris Lattner33daae62010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007715 // If there are modifiers and if we're allowed to parse them, go for it.
7716 Done = !AllowTypeModifiers;
Chris Lattner86df27b2009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007717 while (!Done) {
John McCall187ab372010-03-12 04:21:28 +00007718 switch (char c = *Str++) {
Chris Lattner33daae62010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007719 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
7720 case '*':
7721 case '&': {
7722 // Both pointers and references can have their pointee types
7723 // qualified with an address space.
7724 char *End;
7725 unsigned AddrSpace = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7726 if (End != Str && AddrSpace != 0) {
7727 Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type, AddrSpace);
7728 Str = End;
7729 }
7730 if (c == '*')
7731 Type = Context.getPointerType(Type);
7732 else
7733 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
7734 break;
7735 }
7736 // FIXME: There's no way to have a built-in with an rvalue ref arg.
7737 case 'C':
7738 Type = Type.withConst();
7739 break;
7740 case 'D':
7741 Type = Context.getVolatileType(Type);
7742 break;
Ted Kremenek18932a02012-01-20 21:40:12 +00007743 case 'R':
7744 Type = Type.withRestrict();
7745 break;
Chris Lattner86df27b2009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007746 }
7747 }
Chris Lattner393bd8e2010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007748
Chris Lattner14e0e742010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007749 assert((!RequiresICE || Type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) &&
Chris Lattner393bd8e2010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007750 "Integer constant 'I' type must be an integer");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007751
Chris Lattner86df27b2009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007752 return Type;
7753}
7754
7755/// GetBuiltinType - Return the type for the specified builtin.
Chris Lattner33daae62010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007756QualType ASTContext::GetBuiltinType(unsigned Id,
Chris Lattner14e0e742010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007757 GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007758 unsigned *IntegerConstantArgs) const {
Chris Lattner33daae62010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007759 const char *TypeStr = BuiltinInfo.GetTypeString(Id);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007760
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007761 SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007762
Chris Lattner14e0e742010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007763 bool RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattner86df27b2009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007764 Error = GE_None;
Chris Lattner14e0e742010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007765 QualType ResType = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error,
7766 RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattner86df27b2009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007767 if (Error != GE_None)
7768 return QualType();
Chris Lattner14e0e742010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007769
7770 assert(!RequiresICE && "Result of intrinsic cannot be required to be an ICE");
7771
Chris Lattner86df27b2009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007772 while (TypeStr[0] && TypeStr[0] != '.') {
Chris Lattner14e0e742010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007773 QualType Ty = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error, RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattner86df27b2009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007774 if (Error != GE_None)
7775 return QualType();
7776
Chris Lattner14e0e742010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007777 // If this argument is required to be an IntegerConstantExpression and the
7778 // caller cares, fill in the bitmask we return.
7779 if (RequiresICE && IntegerConstantArgs)
7780 *IntegerConstantArgs |= 1 << ArgTypes.size();
7781
Chris Lattner86df27b2009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007782 // Do array -> pointer decay. The builtin should use the decayed type.
7783 if (Ty->isArrayType())
7784 Ty = getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007785
Chris Lattner86df27b2009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007786 ArgTypes.push_back(Ty);
7787 }
7788
7789 assert((TypeStr[0] != '.' || TypeStr[1] == 0) &&
7790 "'.' should only occur at end of builtin type list!");
7791
John McCall00ccbef2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00007792 FunctionType::ExtInfo EI;
7793 if (BuiltinInfo.isNoReturn(Id)) EI = EI.withNoReturn(true);
7794
7795 bool Variadic = (TypeStr[0] == '.');
7796
7797 // We really shouldn't be making a no-proto type here, especially in C++.
7798 if (ArgTypes.empty() && Variadic)
7799 return getFunctionNoProtoType(ResType, EI);
Douglas Gregorce056bc2010-02-21 22:15:06 +00007800
John McCalle23cf432010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007801 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
John McCall00ccbef2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00007802 EPI.ExtInfo = EI;
7803 EPI.Variadic = Variadic;
John McCalle23cf432010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007804
Jordan Rosebea522f2013-03-08 21:51:21 +00007805 return getFunctionType(ResType, ArgTypes, EPI);
Chris Lattner86df27b2009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007806}
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +00007807
Argyrios Kyrtzidis90e99a82010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007808GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD) {
Rafael Espindola181e3ec2013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007809 if (!FD->isExternallyVisible())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis90e99a82010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007810 return GVA_Internal;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis90e99a82010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007811
Rafael Espindola181e3ec2013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007812 GVALinkage External = GVA_StrongExternal;
7813 switch (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
7814 case TSK_Undeclared:
7815 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
7816 External = GVA_StrongExternal;
7817 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis90e99a82010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007818
Rafael Espindola181e3ec2013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007819 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
7820 return GVA_ExplicitTemplateInstantiation;
7821
7822 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
7823 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
7824 External = GVA_TemplateInstantiation;
7825 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis90e99a82010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007826 }
7827
7828 if (!FD->isInlined())
7829 return External;
David Majnemer13163702013-08-01 17:26:42 +00007830
7831 if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !getLangOpts().MicrosoftMode) ||
7832 FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis90e99a82010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007833 // GNU or C99 inline semantics. Determine whether this symbol should be
7834 // externally visible.
7835 if (FD->isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible())
7836 return External;
7837
7838 // C99 inline semantics, where the symbol is not externally visible.
7839 return GVA_C99Inline;
7840 }
7841
7842 // C++0x [temp.explicit]p9:
7843 // [ Note: The intent is that an inline function that is the subject of
7844 // an explicit instantiation declaration will still be implicitly
7845 // instantiated when used so that the body can be considered for
7846 // inlining, but that no out-of-line copy of the inline function would be
7847 // generated in the translation unit. -- end note ]
7848 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
7849 == TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration)
7850 return GVA_C99Inline;
7851
7852 return GVA_CXXInline;
7853}
7854
7855GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForVariable(const VarDecl *VD) {
Rafael Espindola181e3ec2013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007856 if (!VD->isExternallyVisible())
7857 return GVA_Internal;
7858
Argyrios Kyrtzidis90e99a82010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007859 // If this is a static data member, compute the kind of template
7860 // specialization. Otherwise, this variable is not part of a
7861 // template.
7862 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = TSK_Undeclared;
7863 if (VD->isStaticDataMember())
7864 TSK = VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind();
7865
Rafael Espindola181e3ec2013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007866 switch (TSK) {
7867 case TSK_Undeclared:
7868 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
7869 return GVA_StrongExternal;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis90e99a82010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007870
Rafael Espindola181e3ec2013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007871 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
7872 llvm_unreachable("Variable should not be instantiated");
7873 // Fall through to treat this like any other instantiation.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis90e99a82010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007874
Rafael Espindola181e3ec2013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007875 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
7876 return GVA_ExplicitTemplateInstantiation;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis90e99a82010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007877
Rafael Espindola181e3ec2013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007878 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
7879 return GVA_TemplateInstantiation;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis90e99a82010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007880 }
Rafael Espindola77b50252013-05-13 14:05:53 +00007881
7882 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Linkage!");
Argyrios Kyrtzidis90e99a82010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007883}
7884
Argyrios Kyrtzidis4ac7c0b2010-07-29 20:08:05 +00007885bool ASTContext::DeclMustBeEmitted(const Decl *D) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis90e99a82010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007886 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
7887 if (!VD->isFileVarDecl())
7888 return false;
Richard Smithf396ad92013-04-01 20:22:16 +00007889 } else if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
7890 // We never need to emit an uninstantiated function template.
7891 if (FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate)
7892 return false;
7893 } else
7894 return false;
7895
7896 // If this is a member of a class template, we do not need to emit it.
7897 if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis90e99a82010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007898 return false;
7899
Argyrios Kyrtzidisab411c82010-07-29 20:07:52 +00007900 // Weak references don't produce any output by themselves.
7901 if (D->hasAttr<WeakRefAttr>())
7902 return false;
7903
Argyrios Kyrtzidis90e99a82010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007904 // Aliases and used decls are required.
7905 if (D->hasAttr<AliasAttr>() || D->hasAttr<UsedAttr>())
7906 return true;
7907
7908 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
7909 // Forward declarations aren't required.
Sean Hunt10620eb2011-05-06 20:44:56 +00007910 if (!FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody())
Nick Lewyckydce67a72011-07-18 05:26:13 +00007911 return FD->doesDeclarationForceExternallyVisibleDefinition();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis90e99a82010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007912
7913 // Constructors and destructors are required.
7914 if (FD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>() || FD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>())
7915 return true;
7916
John McCalld5617ee2013-01-25 22:31:03 +00007917 // The key function for a class is required. This rule only comes
7918 // into play when inline functions can be key functions, though.
7919 if (getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) {
7920 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
7921 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = MD->getParent();
7922 if (MD->isOutOfLine() && RD->isDynamicClass()) {
7923 const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunc = getCurrentKeyFunction(RD);
7924 if (KeyFunc && KeyFunc->getCanonicalDecl() == MD->getCanonicalDecl())
7925 return true;
7926 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis90e99a82010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007927 }
7928 }
7929
7930 GVALinkage Linkage = GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD);
7931
7932 // static, static inline, always_inline, and extern inline functions can
7933 // always be deferred. Normal inline functions can be deferred in C99/C++.
7934 // Implicit template instantiations can also be deferred in C++.
7935 if (Linkage == GVA_Internal || Linkage == GVA_C99Inline ||
Anton Yartsev3a5aca82012-02-02 06:06:34 +00007936 Linkage == GVA_CXXInline || Linkage == GVA_TemplateInstantiation)
Argyrios Kyrtzidis90e99a82010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007937 return false;
7938 return true;
7939 }
Douglas Gregor94da1582011-09-10 00:22:34 +00007940
Argyrios Kyrtzidis90e99a82010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007941 const VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(D);
7942 assert(VD->isFileVarDecl() && "Expected file scoped var");
7943
Argyrios Kyrtzidisab411c82010-07-29 20:07:52 +00007944 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly)
7945 return false;
7946
Richard Smith5f9a7e32012-11-12 21:38:00 +00007947 // Variables that can be needed in other TUs are required.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis90e99a82010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007948 GVALinkage L = GetGVALinkageForVariable(VD);
Richard Smith5f9a7e32012-11-12 21:38:00 +00007949 if (L != GVA_Internal && L != GVA_TemplateInstantiation)
7950 return true;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis90e99a82010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007951
Richard Smith5f9a7e32012-11-12 21:38:00 +00007952 // Variables that have destruction with side-effects are required.
7953 if (VD->getType().isDestructedType())
7954 return true;
7955
7956 // Variables that have initialization with side-effects are required.
7957 if (VD->getInit() && VD->getInit()->HasSideEffects(*this))
7958 return true;
7959
7960 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis90e99a82010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007961}
Charles Davis071cc7d2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00007962
Timur Iskhodzhanov8f88a1d2012-07-12 09:50:54 +00007963CallingConv ASTContext::getDefaultCXXMethodCallConv(bool isVariadic) {
Charles Davisee743f92010-11-09 18:04:24 +00007964 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
Timur Iskhodzhanov8f88a1d2012-07-12 09:50:54 +00007965 return ABI->getDefaultMethodCallConv(isVariadic);
7966}
7967
7968CallingConv ASTContext::getCanonicalCallConv(CallingConv CC) const {
John McCallb8b2c9d2013-01-25 22:30:49 +00007969 if (CC == CC_C && !LangOpts.MRTD &&
7970 getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMemberFunctionCCDefault())
Timur Iskhodzhanov8f88a1d2012-07-12 09:50:54 +00007971 return CC_Default;
7972 return CC;
Charles Davisee743f92010-11-09 18:04:24 +00007973}
7974
Jay Foad4ba2a172011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007975bool ASTContext::isNearlyEmpty(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
Anders Carlssondae0cb52010-11-25 01:51:53 +00007976 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
7977 return ABI->isNearlyEmpty(RD);
7978}
7979
Peter Collingbourne14110472011-01-13 18:57:25 +00007980MangleContext *ASTContext::createMangleContext() {
John McCallb8b2c9d2013-01-25 22:30:49 +00007981 switch (Target->getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Tim Northoverc264e162013-01-31 12:13:10 +00007982 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
John McCallb8b2c9d2013-01-25 22:30:49 +00007983 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
7984 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM:
7985 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Peter Collingbourne14110472011-01-13 18:57:25 +00007986 return createItaniumMangleContext(*this, getDiagnostics());
John McCallb8b2c9d2013-01-25 22:30:49 +00007987 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Peter Collingbourne14110472011-01-13 18:57:25 +00007988 return createMicrosoftMangleContext(*this, getDiagnostics());
7989 }
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007990 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI");
Peter Collingbourne14110472011-01-13 18:57:25 +00007991}
7992
Charles Davis071cc7d2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00007993CXXABI::~CXXABI() {}
Ted Kremenekba29bd22011-04-28 04:53:38 +00007994
7995size_t ASTContext::getSideTableAllocatedMemory() const {
Larisse Voufoef4579c2013-08-06 01:03:05 +00007996 return ASTRecordLayouts.getMemorySize() +
7997 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCLayouts) +
7998 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(KeyFunctions) +
7999 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCImpls) +
8000 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(BlockVarCopyInits) +
8001 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(DeclAttrs) +
8002 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(TemplateOrInstantiation) +
8003 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingDecl) +
8004 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl) +
8005 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl) +
8006 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(OverriddenMethods) +
8007 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(Types) +
8008 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(VariableArrayTypes) +
8009 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ClassScopeSpecializationPattern);
Ted Kremenekba29bd22011-04-28 04:53:38 +00008010}
Ted Kremenekd211cb72011-10-06 05:00:56 +00008011
Eli Friedman5e867c82013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008012void ASTContext::setManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND, unsigned Number) {
8013 if (Number > 1)
8014 MangleNumbers[ND] = Number;
David Blaikie66cff722012-11-14 01:52:05 +00008015}
8016
Eli Friedman5e867c82013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008017unsigned ASTContext::getManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND) const {
8018 llvm::DenseMap<const NamedDecl *, unsigned>::const_iterator I =
8019 MangleNumbers.find(ND);
8020 return I != MangleNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
David Blaikie66cff722012-11-14 01:52:05 +00008021}
8022
Eli Friedman5e867c82013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008023MangleNumberingContext &
8024ASTContext::getManglingNumberContext(const DeclContext *DC) {
Eli Friedman07369dd2013-07-01 20:22:57 +00008025 return MangleNumberingContexts[DC];
Douglas Gregor9e8c92a2012-02-20 19:44:39 +00008026}
8027
Ted Kremenekd211cb72011-10-06 05:00:56 +00008028void ASTContext::setParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D, unsigned int index) {
8029 ParamIndices[D] = index;
8030}
8031
8032unsigned ASTContext::getParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D) const {
8033 ParameterIndexTable::const_iterator I = ParamIndices.find(D);
8034 assert(I != ParamIndices.end() &&
8035 "ParmIndices lacks entry set by ParmVarDecl");
8036 return I->second;
8037}
Fariborz Jahanian538bbe52013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008038
Richard Smith211c8dd2013-06-05 00:46:14 +00008039APValue *
8040ASTContext::getMaterializedTemporaryValue(const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *E,
8041 bool MayCreate) {
8042 assert(E && E->getStorageDuration() == SD_Static &&
8043 "don't need to cache the computed value for this temporary");
8044 if (MayCreate)
8045 return &MaterializedTemporaryValues[E];
8046
8047 llvm::DenseMap<const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *, APValue>::iterator I =
8048 MaterializedTemporaryValues.find(E);
8049 return I == MaterializedTemporaryValues.end() ? 0 : &I->second;
8050}
8051
Fariborz Jahanian538bbe52013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008052bool ASTContext::AtomicUsesUnsupportedLibcall(const AtomicExpr *E) const {
8053 const llvm::Triple &T = getTargetInfo().getTriple();
8054 if (!T.isOSDarwin())
8055 return false;
8056
8057 QualType AtomicTy = E->getPtr()->getType()->getPointeeType();
8058 CharUnits sizeChars = getTypeSizeInChars(AtomicTy);
8059 uint64_t Size = sizeChars.getQuantity();
8060 CharUnits alignChars = getTypeAlignInChars(AtomicTy);
8061 unsigned Align = alignChars.getQuantity();
8062 unsigned MaxInlineWidthInBits = getTargetInfo().getMaxAtomicInlineWidth();
8063 return (Size != Align || toBits(sizeChars) > MaxInlineWidthInBits);
8064}
Reid Klecknercff15122013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008065
8066namespace {
8067
8068 /// \brief A \c RecursiveASTVisitor that builds a map from nodes to their
8069 /// parents as defined by the \c RecursiveASTVisitor.
8070 ///
8071 /// Note that the relationship described here is purely in terms of AST
8072 /// traversal - there are other relationships (for example declaration context)
8073 /// in the AST that are better modeled by special matchers.
8074 ///
8075 /// FIXME: Currently only builds up the map using \c Stmt and \c Decl nodes.
8076 class ParentMapASTVisitor : public RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> {
8077
8078 public:
8079 /// \brief Builds and returns the translation unit's parent map.
8080 ///
8081 /// The caller takes ownership of the returned \c ParentMap.
8082 static ASTContext::ParentMap *buildMap(TranslationUnitDecl &TU) {
8083 ParentMapASTVisitor Visitor(new ASTContext::ParentMap);
8084 Visitor.TraverseDecl(&TU);
8085 return Visitor.Parents;
8086 }
8087
8088 private:
8089 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> VisitorBase;
8090
8091 ParentMapASTVisitor(ASTContext::ParentMap *Parents) : Parents(Parents) {
8092 }
8093
8094 bool shouldVisitTemplateInstantiations() const {
8095 return true;
8096 }
8097 bool shouldVisitImplicitCode() const {
8098 return true;
8099 }
8100 // Disables data recursion. We intercept Traverse* methods in the RAV, which
8101 // are not triggered during data recursion.
8102 bool shouldUseDataRecursionFor(clang::Stmt *S) const {
8103 return false;
8104 }
8105
8106 template <typename T>
8107 bool TraverseNode(T *Node, bool(VisitorBase:: *traverse) (T *)) {
8108 if (Node == NULL)
8109 return true;
8110 if (ParentStack.size() > 0)
8111 // FIXME: Currently we add the same parent multiple times, for example
8112 // when we visit all subexpressions of template instantiations; this is
8113 // suboptimal, bug benign: the only way to visit those is with
8114 // hasAncestor / hasParent, and those do not create new matches.
8115 // The plan is to enable DynTypedNode to be storable in a map or hash
8116 // map. The main problem there is to implement hash functions /
8117 // comparison operators for all types that DynTypedNode supports that
8118 // do not have pointer identity.
8119 (*Parents)[Node].push_back(ParentStack.back());
8120 ParentStack.push_back(ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*Node));
8121 bool Result = (this ->* traverse) (Node);
8122 ParentStack.pop_back();
8123 return Result;
8124 }
8125
8126 bool TraverseDecl(Decl *DeclNode) {
8127 return TraverseNode(DeclNode, &VisitorBase::TraverseDecl);
8128 }
8129
8130 bool TraverseStmt(Stmt *StmtNode) {
8131 return TraverseNode(StmtNode, &VisitorBase::TraverseStmt);
8132 }
8133
8134 ASTContext::ParentMap *Parents;
8135 llvm::SmallVector<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode, 16> ParentStack;
8136
8137 friend class RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor>;
8138 };
8139
8140} // end namespace
8141
8142ASTContext::ParentVector
8143ASTContext::getParents(const ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode &Node) {
8144 assert(Node.getMemoizationData() &&
8145 "Invariant broken: only nodes that support memoization may be "
8146 "used in the parent map.");
8147 if (!AllParents) {
8148 // We always need to run over the whole translation unit, as
8149 // hasAncestor can escape any subtree.
8150 AllParents.reset(
8151 ParentMapASTVisitor::buildMap(*getTranslationUnitDecl()));
8152 }
8153 ParentMap::const_iterator I = AllParents->find(Node.getMemoizationData());
8154 if (I == AllParents->end()) {
8155 return ParentVector();
8156 }
8157 return I->second;
8158}
Fariborz Jahanianad4aaf12013-07-15 21:22:08 +00008159
8160bool
8161ASTContext::ObjCMethodsAreEqual(const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodDecl,
8162 const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodImpl) {
8163 // No point trying to match an unavailable/deprecated mothod.
8164 if (MethodDecl->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>()
8165 || MethodDecl->hasAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
8166 return false;
8167 if (MethodDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier() !=
8168 MethodImpl->getObjCDeclQualifier())
8169 return false;
8170 if (!hasSameType(MethodDecl->getResultType(),
8171 MethodImpl->getResultType()))
8172 return false;
8173
8174 if (MethodDecl->param_size() != MethodImpl->param_size())
8175 return false;
8176
8177 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator IM = MethodImpl->param_begin(),
8178 IF = MethodDecl->param_begin(), EM = MethodImpl->param_end(),
8179 EF = MethodDecl->param_end();
8180 IM != EM && IF != EF; ++IM, ++IF) {
8181 const ParmVarDecl *DeclVar = (*IF);
8182 const ParmVarDecl *ImplVar = (*IM);
8183 if (ImplVar->getObjCDeclQualifier() != DeclVar->getObjCDeclQualifier())
8184 return false;
8185 if (!hasSameType(DeclVar->getType(), ImplVar->getType()))
8186 return false;
8187 }
8188 return (MethodDecl->isVariadic() == MethodImpl->isVariadic());
8189
8190}